Location via proxy:   [ UP ]  
[Report a bug]   [Manage cookies]                

MGB Workshop Manual

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 417
MGB Workshop Manual Publication Part No. AKD 3259 (14th Edition) © Leyland Cars—Service Cowley, Oxford OX4 2PG, England MGB. CONTENTS Introduction Maintenance Lubrication Chart General Data Engine Tuning Data Engng Engine (Local and territorial requirements) Ignition System Cooling System Fuel System Fuel System (Evaporative Loss) .. Clutch Gearbox. Overdrive Gearbox (All Synchromesh) —.. Overdrive(TypeLH) Automatic Gearbox... : PropellerShaft. Rear Axle and Rear Suspension (Three-quarter-floating Type) .. Rear Axle and Rear Suspension (Semi-floating Type) SteeringGear. Steering Gear (Energy Absorbing Column) Front Suspension Hydraulic Dampers. Braking System Braking System (Tandem Master Cylinder)... Electrical System. Electrical System (Local and Territorial Requirements) Wiring Diagrams. , WheelsandTyres Body ee Body (Local and Territorial Requirements) Service Tools. ww Recommended Lubricants .. Issue 3. 86842 T8DAMGNO STREET OH, mM Nang MILEY STOCKPOHT oe fs 2 ioe 83 278) J SEecialst rons to Land Rover -m 108 and repairs to aii, AF Sate ‘mekes— MOT Station = . Na ww Re a8 . End of Manual MAINTENANCE SUMMARY RH.D. and L.H.D. except North America—continued ACTION OPERATION X £ a > » ° Refit engine drain plug Refit gearbox drain plug Refit gearbox drain plug (every 24,000 miles) Paint timing marks (early models) Lower lift Fit exhaust extractor pipe Renew engine oil filter Check/top up gearbox oil Fill gearbox with oil Fill gearbox with oil (every 24,000 miles) Check/adjust torque of cylinder head nuts Check/adjust torque of rocker shaft nuts Check/adjust torque of manifold nuts ‘Check/adjust valve clearances Fill engine with oil x ‘Check/top up engine oil Lubricate water pump (early models only) Lubricate dynamo bearing (early models only) Top up carburetter piston dampers Lubricate accelerator control, linkage and pedal pivot Renew air cleaner elements Check security of accessible engine mountings ‘Check driving belts, adjust or renew Clean/adjust spark plugs Renew spark plugs | Clean and test crankcase breather valve Check/top up clutch fluid reservoir Check/top up brake fluid reservoir ‘Check/top up windscreen washer reservoir Check/top up cooling system Renew fuel line filter Clean brake servo filter Check cooling and heater systems for leaks Run engine and check sealing of filter, stop engine Recheck/top up engine oil ‘Connect instruments and check data Check/adjust distributor points, renew if necessary ‘Check volt drop between coil CB and earth Lubricate distributor Run engine Disconnect vacuum pipe, check dwell angle, adjust points as. necessary Using electronic ‘Check stroboscopic ignition timing equipment Check distributor automatic advance. ‘Check advance increase as vacuum pipe is reconnected Check throttle operation, check/adjust carburetter idle speed and mixture settings ‘Check/top up automatic gearbox fluid Stop engine e Remove wing covers xxeoes xx@eeece @ e x x KX Xx xx x xxx xXx x xx xx x x x XxX xx xx XOX x XOX OX Xx xxx xxx xxx x@xxxex xOxxx@xex xxx xxx xxx @ox os eox Maintenance 2 MGB. Issue 2. 6842 MAINTENANCE SUMMARY R.HLD. and L.H.D. except North America—continued ACTION After Sales | A | B | C OPERATION X x |x] x Lubricate all locks and hinges (not steering lock) eje Fill in details and fix appropriate Unipart underbonnet stickers @ | @ | © | Close bonnet x |x | x Check and if necessary renew windscreen wiper blades Remove exhaust extractor pipe @ | @ © | Remove spare wheel x |x] x Check spare tyre complies with manufacturer's specification x |x | x Check depth of tread x |x |x] x Check visually for external cuts in tyre fabric x |x |x] x Check visually for external exposure of ply or cord x | xX |x] x Check visually for external lumps or bulges x |x |x [x Check/adjust tyre pressure x |x | x Check fuel filler pipe connections @ | @ | © | @ | Refit spare wheel. Drive car off lift. Remove rear compartment floor covering and access panel x |x| x Check/top up battery electrolyte x |x Clean and grease battery connections @ © © | © | Refit rear compartment floor covering and access panel x |x| x] x Check/adjust headlamp alignment x |x Check/adjust front wheel alignment x |x] x Carry out road or roller test and check function of all instrumentation x |x |x Report and additional work required x | x1x]x Ensure cleanliness of controls, door handles, steering wheel, etc This Maintenance Summary was produced from Leycare Supplementary Job Sheet AKD 8469 (Ist Edition). Job sheets used by British Leyland Distributors and Dealers operating Leycare Service are updated as modifications affecting routine maintenance are introduced and the content of this maintenance summary may differ from that currently used by Leycare Service operatives. MGB. Tissue 2. 86842 airs Land ROME! NAOT ecetor salist reO8iT TS go ail me Service an £2 Maintenance 3 MAINTENANCE SUMMARY NORTH AMERICA ‘The following items should be checked weekly by the driver: Engine oil level Brake fluid level Battery electrolyte level Radiator coolant level Windshield washer reservoir level All tyre pressures All lights for operation Horn operation Windshield wipers operation MAINTENANCE INTERVALS (2.5) + These items are emission related (=~ Carry out the services indicated by X in column The Lubrication Service at 3,000-mile or 3-month intervals A at 6,000-mile or 6-month intervals B at 12,000-mile or 12-month intervals *Specified otherwise LUBRICATION Lubricate all points. Renew engine oil Renew engine oil filter. Check level of all fluid reservoirs, brake, clutch, battery, rear axle, transmission, cooling system and windshield washer. ENGINE +Check all drive belts; adjust if necessary. +Check all hoses, vacuum, air and water for condition and tightness +Renew all air filter cleaner elements (air pump and carburetter), tCheck restrictor in rocker cover purge line for obstruction. Adjust valve rocker clearances. {Check gulp valve operation (renew if necessary) FUEL SYSTEM Renew fuel line filter Check condition of fuel filler cap seal Check fuel pipes and unions for chafing, corrosion and leaks. Top up carburetter piston dampers. OSCILLOSCOPE AND COMBUSTION CHECK Check distributor points, resistance and dwell. +Renew distributor points. Check ignition timing and distributor advance or retard characteristics. Check engine idle speed +Check spark plugs (cruise and unload condition). +Renew spark plugs Check distributor cap and wires. Check charging system output Power check, engine cylinder comparison. Check choke and carburetter fast idle speed setting Check exhaust emission (CO HO) at idle. Maintenance 4 Lubrication Service | A | B x Koh x x, x x x. x x. x, x x, x. x, x, x x. x x x. xX. x. x x. Xx. x. x, x. x x, x. Kooy Kod Mig x. Ky x. Xx. x. x. x MGB. Isue2, 86842 MAINTENANCE SUMMARY North America—continued SAFETY Check/adjust front wheel alignment. Check visually hydraulic pipes, unions for chafing, leaks and corrosion Check/adjust handbrake operation. Inspect the brake pads for wear and discs for condition. Inspect brake linings and pads for wear, drums and discs for condition Check/adjust headlights Check tyres visually, and report depth of tread, cuts in fabric, exposure of ply or cord structure, lumps or bulges Check wiper blades for condition. Check condition, operation and security of seats, seat belts/interlock Check operation of all door locks and window controls ROAD TEST Ensure that operation of vehicle is satisfactory and report all items requiring attention 24,000-miles or 24-month intervals *tRenew all drive belts *+Check air pump (correct or renew if necessary) Renew adsorption canister *tRenew distributor cap and wires * Clean overdrive filter 36,000-miles or 36-month intervals *Renew alll hydraulic brake seals x KKK xxx KK KKK | ‘The maintenance summary on this and the preceding page is the minimum service required to maintain your vehicle under normal driving conditions. For other than normal dri we recommend that you consult your Dealer. MGB. Issue 1. 96842 ing conditions, and those caused by seasonal changes, Maintenance 5 + LUBRICATION CHART R.H.D. and L.H.D. EXCEPT NORTH AMERICA. =| no 2318, NOTE:~Ensure that the vehicle is standing on a level surface when checking the oil levels. Weekly (1) ENGINE, Check oil level, and top up if necessary, Every 6,000 miles or 6 months (2), ENGINE. Drain and refil with new oil (3)_ ENGINE OIL FILTER. Remove the disposable cartridge, fit Early cars: Drain filter, wash filter bowl in fuel and fit new clement (4) CARBURETTERS. Top up carburetter piston dampers. (5) ACCELERATOR. Lubricate accelerator control linkage, cable ‘and pedal fulerum, (6) DISTRIBUTOR. Lubricate all parts as necessary (1D) REAR AXLE. Check oll level, and top up if necessary. (8) GEARBOX AND OVERDRIVE. Check oil level, and top up if necessary. o ao ay ay Every aay AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION. Check Muid level, and top up if necessary FRONT SUSPENSION (6 nipples) HAND BRAKE CABLE (1 nipple) | Give three o AND MECHANICAL LINKAGE. | Strokes with a PROPELLER SHAFT (I nipple) _| 88° gun. LOCKS AND HINGES. Lubricate the bonnet release safety catch and all locks and hinges. Give three or four 24,000 miles or 24 months GEARBOX WITH OVERDRIVE. Drain, clean overdrive filters and refill with new oil Optional lubrication at 3,000 miles or 3 months ay ENGINE. Check oil level and top up if necessary. Recommended oils and greases are given at the end of the manual MGB. Issue 1. 86842 LUBRICATION CHART NORTH AMERICA Ino 236 NOTE:—Ensure that the vehicle is standing on a level surface when checking the oil levels. Weekly (0) ENGINE. Check oil level, and top up if necessary. Lubrication service every 3,000 miles or 3 months @) ENGINE. Drain and refill with new oil. @) THROTTLE AND CHOKE. Lubricate throttle and choke control linkages, cables, and accelerator pedal (4) REAR AXLE. Check oil level, and top up if necessary. (5) GEARBOX AND OVERDRIVE. Check oil level, and top up if necessary. (6) PROPELLER SHAFT (I nipple) Give three or four (7) FRONT SUSPENSION (6 nipples) strokes with a (8) HAND BRAKE CABLE (I nipple) J grease gun. (9) WHEELS AND HUBS. Lubricate wire wheel and hub splines. LOCKS, HINGES AND LINKAGES. Lubricate all door, bonnet and boot locks and hinges; and the hand brake mechanical linkage. FRICTION POINTS. Spray lubricant on all friction points, ‘A’ service every 6,000 miles or 6 months; AND ‘B’ service every 12,000 miles or 12 months (00) ENGINE OIL FILTER. Remove disposable cartridge, it new. (11) CARBURETTERS. Top up carburetter piston dampers. (12) DISTRIBUTOR. Lubricate all parts as necessary. Every 24,000 miles or 24 months (13) GEARBOX WITH OVERDRIVE. Drain, clean over- drive filter, refill with new oil, Recommended oils and greases are given at the end of the manual 4 MGB. Issue 1. 86842 Maintenance 7 GENERAL DATA (18G/18GA) ENGINE ‘Type Number of cylinders. Bore Stroke Capacity Combustion chamber volume (valves fitted) Firing order Valve operation Compression ratio: H.C. Le. Compression pressure: H.C. Le. Torque: H.C. Le Engine idle speed (approx.) Oversize bore: First Max. Crankshaft Main journal diameter Crankpin journal diameter . Crankshaft end-thrust Crankshaft end-float Main bearings Number and type Material. Length . Diametrical clearance Undersizes Connecting rods Type Length between centres Big-end bearings Type Material Length Diametrical clearance Undersizes End-float on crankpin (nominal)... Pistons Type - S Clearance in cylinder: Top Bottom .. Number of rings : Width of ring grooves: Top Second : Third : Oil control Gudgeon pin bore MGB. Issue 7. 80619 18G, 18GA. 4 3.16 in. (80.26 mm). 3.5 in. (89 mm.) 1798 cc. (109.8 cu. in.) 42.5 10 43.5 cc. (2.59 to 2.65 cu. in). 1,3,4,2 Overhead by push-rod. 88:1. 8.021. 160 tb./sq. in. (11.25 kg./em2). 130 Ib./sq. in. (9.15 kg,/em2). 110 Ib. ft. (15.2 kgm.) at 3,000 r.p.m. 105 Ib. ft. (14.5 kg.m.) at 3,000 r.p.m. 500 r.p.m. .010 in, (.254 mm). .040 in. (1.016 mm.). 2.1262 to 2.127 in, (54.01 to $4.02 mm.).. 1.8759 to 1.8764 in. (47.648 to 47.661 mm.). Taken on thrust washers at centre main bearing 004 to .005 in. (.10 to .13 mm.), Three thinwall. Steclbacked copper-lead 1b in. (28.5 mm.). 001 to .0027 in. (.0254 to .068 mm.). 010, ~.020, ~.030 and ~.040 in, (—.254, 762 and —1,016 mm.). -.508, Angular-split big-end, split clamp small-end. 65 in. (165.1 mm.) Shell Steel-backed coppertead. .995 to 1.008 in, (25.2 to 25.52 mm). .001 to .0027 in. (.0254 to .068 mm.). ~.010, —.020, ~.030 and ~.040 in. (~.254, ~.508, =.762 and ~1.016 mm.). .008 to .012 in, (.20 to 30 mm,). Aluminium solid skirt. 0036 to .0045 in. (.091 to .121 mm.). 0018 to .0024 in. (.045 to .060 mm.). 4(3 compression, | oil control). 064 to .065 in. (1.625 to 1.651 mm.). -1578 to .1588 in. (4.008 to 4.033 mm.). -7501 to .7503 in. (19.052 to 19.057 mm.). General Data 1 GENERAL DATA~-continued (18G/18GA-continued) Piston rings COMPRESSION Type: Top. Second and third Width: Top Second and third Fitted gap: Top “ Second and third Ring to groove clearance: Top Second and third OIL CONTROL Type . Width Be Fitted gap : Ring to groove clearance Gudgeon Type Fit in piston Diameter (outer) Camshaft Journal diameters: Front Centre Rear .. ; Front Bearing liner inside diameter] (1 (reamed after fitting): |} Rn Diametrical clearance End-thrust End-float Cam lft .. Drive . Timing chain... Tappets Type Outside diameter Length Rocker gear ROCKER SHAFT Length Diameter ROCKER ARM Bore .. oa Rocker arm bush inside diameter Ratio. Valves Seat angle: Inlet and exhaust Head diameter: Inlet Exhaust .. Stem diameter: Inlet Exhaust .. Stem to guide clearance: Inlet Exhaust Valve lift: Inlet and exhaust General Data 2 Parallel \ Tapered f ist iton-molybdenum filled. 0615 to .0625 in, (1.562 to 1.587 mm. 012 to .017 in, (.304 to .431 mm.). } (0015 to .0035 in, (,038 to .088 mm.) Slotted scraper. 1552 to .1562 in. (3.94 to 3.96 mm.). 012 to .017 in. (.304 to .431 mm.), 0016 to .0036 in. (.04 to .09 mm.), Semi-floating. Free-fit at 20°C. (68°F.). .7499 10 .7501 in, (19.04 to 19.05 mm.). 1,78875 to 1.78925 in. (45.424 to 45.437 mm. 1.72875 to 1.72925 in. (43.910 to 43.923 mm. 1.62275 to 1.62325 in. (41.218 to 41.230 mm.), 1.79025 to 1.79075 in. (45.472 to 45.485 mm.).. 1.73025 to 1.73075 in, (43.948 to 43.961 mm.).. 1.62425 to 1.62475 in, (41.256 to 41.269 mm.).. .001 to .002 in, (.0254 to .0508 mm.). ‘Taken on locating plate. 003 to .007 in, (.076 to .178 mm). .250 in. (6,35 mm.). Chain and sprocket from crankshaft Hin, (9.52 mm.). pitch x 52 pitches. Barrel with flat base. 4B in. (20.64 mm.). 2.293 to 2.303 in, (58.25 to 58.5 mm.). 624 to .625 in, (15.85 to 15.87 mm.). -7485 to .7495 in, (19.01 to 19.26 mm.), -6255 to .626 in. (15.8 to 15.9 mm, 14 asus, 1,562 to 1.567 in, (38.67 to 38.80 mm). 1.343 to 1.348 in, (34.11 to 34.23 mm.). 3422 to .3427 in, (8.68 to 8.69 mm.) 3417 to .3422 in, (8.660 to 8.661 mm.). 0015 to .0025 in, (.0381 to .0778 mm.). .002 to .003 in, (.0508 to .0762 mm.). 3645 in, (9.25 mm.) MGB. Issue 7. 80619 GENERAL DATA~continued (18G/18GA—continued) Valve guides Length: Inlet. Exhaust... Outside diameter: Inlet and exhaust Inside diameter: Inlet and exhaust Fitted height above head: Inlet and exhaust Interference fit in head: Inlet and exhaust (Later cars) Length: Inlet S Fitting height above head: Inlet Valve springs Free length: | Inner .. Outer Fitted length: Inner - Outer Load at fitted length: Inner Outer Load at top of ift: Inner. Outer - Valve crash speed... Valve timing Timing marks - Rocker clearance: Running. Timing Inlet valve: Opens Closes... Exhaust valve: Opens Closes ENGINE LUBRICATION System. System pressure: Running. dling Oil pump Capacity Oil filter. By-pass valve opens Oil pressure relief valve Relief valve spring: Free length Fitted length Load at fitted length FUEL SYSTEM Carburetters Choke diameter... Fetsize : Needles a Piston spring =. Aircleaners 0 Fuel pump Type (Early cars)... Minimum flow... MGB. Isue6. 69615 1 fin. (41.275 mm.) 2b in. (55.95 mm.) 5635 to .5640 in, (14.30 to 14.32 mm). 3442 to .3447 in. (8.73 to 8.74 mm,). in, (15.875 mm). .0005 to .00175 in. (.012 to .044 mm.) 1 Fin. (47.63 mm.) 34 in, (19 mm). 142 in. (50.0 mm.) 2d in. (54.4 mm.). 17 in. 36.5 mm,). 1& in. 39.7 mm). 28 to 32 Ib. (12.7 to 14.5 kg). 72 Ib. (32.7 kg). 48 to 52 Ib. (21.7 to 23.6 kg.) 117 Ib. (53 kg.). 6,200 r-p.m. Dimples on camshaft and crankshaft wheels. O15 in. (.38 mm.) cold. .055 in, (1.4 mm.) 16°BT.D.C. 56°ABD.C. S1°BBD.. 21° ATDC. Wet sump, pressure fed. Between 50 and 80 Ib./sq. in. (3.51 and 5.6 kg,/em.4). Between 10 and 25 Ib./sq. in. (.7 and 1.7 kg./em.).. Hobourn-Eaton or eccentric rotor. 3% gal./min, at 2,000 r.p.m. Tecalemit full-flow felt element. 13 to 17 Ib,/sq. in. (9 to 1.1 kg,fem). 70 Ib./sq. in. (4.9 kg.fem?).. 3 in, (76.2 mm.). 2 de in. (54.7 mm). 18.5 to 16.5 Ib. (7.0 to 7.4 kg,). ‘Twin $.U. type HS4. 1% in, (38.1 mm). .090 in, (2.2 mm.). No. 5 (Standard), No. 6 (Rich), No. 21 (Weak). Red. Copper paper element. S.U. electric HP. 7 gal,fht. (31.8 litres/hr., 8.4 US. gal./hr.). General Data 3 GENERAL DATA~continued (18G/18GA-continued) Suction head Delivery head : Minimum starting voltage. ‘Type (Later cars) . Minimum flow Suction head COOLING SYSTEM Type Thermostat setting Standard 5 6 Hot climate ; : Coldclimate - Pressurecap www Fan blades : 5 a Fan belt: Width So a Outside length. 5 o 6 Thickness. - Tension .. ‘Type of pump Pump drive IGNITION SYSTEM Coil , Resistance at 20°C. (68°F.): Primary winding Consumption: Ignition switchon At2,000npm Distributor . Rotation of rotor Cam form Cam closed period Cam opened period Automatic advance Automatic advance commences... Maximum advance (crankshaft degrees) Vacuum advance (crankshaft degrees) . Decelerating check (crankshaft degrees, engine r.p.m.) Contact point gap setting Breaker spring tension Condenser capacity ‘Timing marks Static ignition timing: H.C Le. Stroboscopic ignition timing: H.C. Le. . Suppressors Sparking plugs .. Size .. Gap . General Data 4 2 ft, 6 in, (76.2 em.). 4 ft. (122 em). 9.5 volts. S.U. electric AUF 300, 15 gal./hr. (68.2 litre/hr. 18 U.S. gal./hr.). 18 in. (457 mm.) Pressurized, Pump-impeller- and fan-assisted. 74°C. (165°F.). 74°C. (165°F.). 82°C, (180°F.). 7b. (3.175 kg.). Bat 24°, Vin. (9.5 mm). 354 in. (90.2 em.).. fe in. (7.9 mm.), ‘4 in, (12.8 mm.) movement. Centrifugal. Belt from crankshaft pulley. HA.12 (oikfilled). 3.1 to 3.5 ohms (cold). 3.9 amps, 1.4 amps. 25D4. Anti-clockwise, 4-oylinder high-ift 60°33", 30 43% Centrifugal and vacuum. Serial Number Serial Number 40897 (H.C) 40916 (L.C.) 400 r-p.m, 400 r.p.m. 20° at 200 r-p.m. 24° at 4,400 rp.m, 20° at 13 in, (33.3 em.) 16° at 12 in. (30.5 om.). Hg. Hg. 20° at 2,200 r.p.m. 24° at 4,400 rp.m. 15°at 1,600 r.p.m. 18° at 3,000 p.m. 9° at 900 r.p.n, 9° at 1,000 r.p.m. 6° at 700 rpm. 8° at 800 rpm. 6° at 600 r.p.m. 6° at 600 r.p.m. 014 to .016 in. (.35 to 40 mm.). 18 to 24 02. (510 to 680 gm.) 18 0.24 mF. Pointer on timing chain case and notch on crankshaft pulley. 10°B.T-D.C. (98/100-octane fuel). 8°B.T.DC. (95/97-octane fuel 14°B.T.D.C. at 600 p.m.” 12°B.T.D.C. at 600 r.p.m. Lucas W55 Type L.2. Fitted in plug leads. Champion N9Y. 14 mm. % in. (19.0 mm.) reach. 024 to .026 in. (.625 to .660 mm.). MGB. Issue6. 69615 GENERAL DATA~continued (18G/18GA-continued) CLUTCH Makeand type ww Diaphragm spring colour... Clutch plate diameter : Facing material... ‘Number of damper springs Damper spring load Damper spring colour Clutch release bearing. Cluteh fluid GEARBOX AND OVERDRIVE Number of forward gears Gearbox ratios: Reverse .. First Second .. Third Fourth Overdrive ratio. : Overall gear ratios: Reverse First Second Third Fourth. Top gear speed per 1,000 r.p.m.: Standard Overdrive .. Standard Overdrive Synchromesh hub springs: Free length Fitted length Load at fitted length Shaft and reverse plunger detent springs: Free length Fitted length Speedometer gear ratio: Load at fitted length Reverse plunger springs: Free length .. Fitted length Load at fitted length Mainshaft second and third gear end-float Laygear end-float Overdrive Pump spring: Free length Rate Clutch spring: Free length Rate PROPELLER SHAFT Type Universal joints Angular movement. Overall length: Fully extended: Standard Overdrive Fully compressed: Standard Overdrive. Length of shaft assembly: Standard Overdrive Tube diameter... MGB. Issue 9, 25729 Borg & Beck 8 in, DS. Dark blue. 8 in, (20.32 om.) Wound yarn. 6. 110 to 120 Ib. (49.8 to 54.3 kg). Black/light green. Graphite (MY3D). Lockheed Disc Brake Fluid (Series 11). GG. diaphragm spring. 4. 4.76 3.64: 221 137: 1.00: 802 :1 18.588 : 1. 14.214: 1 8.656 : 1. Overdrive 5.3691 4.306 : 1 3.909 : 1 3.13511 17.9 mph, (27.3 km.p. 22.3 m.p.h. (35.5 km.p. 9/28. 5/16. %in, (12.7 mm). ii in, (7.9 mm.) 4 to 5 Ib. (1.8 to 2.2 kg). 14 in, (30.16 mm.). % in, (19.0 mm.).. 18 to 20 Ib. (8.16 to 9.07 kg.). Lin, (25.4 mm.). HE in, (20.63 mm). 91% to 92% Ib. (41.4 to 41.9 kg. 004 10.006 in. (.10 to .15 mm.). 002 to .003 in. (.05 to .08 mm.). 2.000 in. (50.8 mm). 11 1b. in, (12.7 kg.em.). 1.510 in. (38.3 mm.). 154 Tb. in, (178 kg. cm.) Open tubular, telescopic. Hardy Spicer needle roller. 18° to 20° 30% in. (78.1 em.) 31%in. (81 em). 29% in. (74 em). 30% in. (76.5 em.). 254b in, (64.3 em). 26% in. (67 em.). 2 in, (50.8 mm.) Goneral Data $ GENERAL DATA continued (18G/18GA~continued) REAR AXLE ‘Type Ratio Differential bearing preload Pinion bearing preload oo Backlash adjustment: Crown wheel. Pinion STEERING Type Steexing-wheel diameter Tumns—tock to lock... Turning circle .. Universal joint Pinion end-float a Damper end-float : Toe-in. Angle of outer wheel with inner whee! at 20° FRONT SUSPENSION Type. Spring: Coil diameter (mean) Free height .. Static length at 1,030 b. (467.2 ) load. Number of free coils Camber angle .. Castor angle King pin inclination .. Dampers ‘Arm centres, Wheel bearing end-float REAR SUSPENSION Type Number of spring leaves Width of springleaves . Gauge of leaves, Ealydrs . Later cars. Working load (215 1b. [7 *eD Early cars... - Later cars Dampers ‘Arm centres ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT System .. a Charging system Batteries—two 6-volt .. 5 Capacity: 10-hourrate 20-hour rate Plates per cell. Electrolyte to fill one cell. General Data 6 > Hypoid, three-quarter-floating, 3.909 : 1 (11/43). .002 in. (.05 mm.) ‘nip’ per bearing, 7 t0.9 Ib. in, (.8 to 1.0 kgm.) Shims. Head washer. Rack and pinion. 16% in, (419.10 mm.). 2.93. 32 ft. (9.75 m.). Hardy Spicer KOS18, GB166. 002 to .005 in. (.05 to .12 mm). 0005 t0 .003 in. (.012 to.076 mm.) (unladen). Heto sin, (1.5 to 2.3 mm.) (unladen). 191s, Independent. Coil spring and wishbone. 3.238 in, (82.2 mm.). 9.94 te in, (251.421.5 mm.). 74 dyin. (17848 mm.). 738. Nominal 1° positive (#4°, — 14°) =1%4 "positive, 4° negative Nominal 7°(+%° ° to Th? Nominal 8°(+1°, —%°)=7%° to 9° Ammstrong piston type. 8 in, (203.2 mm.). .002 to .004 in. (.05 to .10 mm), (unladen). Semi-elliptic leaf spring. 5+ bottom plate. Interleaving 1/2, 2/3, 3/4. 1% in, (44.4 mm.). rin. (5.56 mm.) 3 at dein. (5.6 mm.), 3 at Win, (4.8 mm). 400 Ib. (181.5 kg). 450 tb. (204.1 kg) Armstrong piston type. 5% in, (133 mm.). 12-volt, positive earth. Current/voltage control Lucas SG9E or STGZ9E. Lucas BT9E or BTZ9E-later cars. SI amp--hr. 58 amp-hr. 9° 1 pint (570 c.c.: 1.2 US. pints). MGB. Issue9. 25729 GENERAL DATA-continued (18G/18GA-continued) Regulator... Voltage setting at 3,000 r.p. 2 10°C. (50°F) 20°C. (68°F.) 30°C. (86°F.) 40°C. (104°F.) Current setting at 4,000 r.p.m. ne Cut-out relay: Cut-in voltage .. . Drop-off voltage Reverse current ~ Current regulator . Dynamo Maximum output .. Cut-in speed Field resistance . - Brush spring tension Drive .. Drive adjustment Starter motor Lock torque Torque at 1,000 r.p.m. Brush spring tension Starter gear ratio .. Wiper motor Drive to wheelboxes Armature end-float Running current .. Wiping speed Horns Type... ne Maximum current consumption BRAKES Type. Brake fluid Front diameter Pad material Swept area . Rear Drum diameter Lining material Swept area Lining dimensions WHEELS Type Size: Dise Wire MGB. Issue 11. 83910 RB.340. 14,9 to 15.5 volts. 14.7 to 15.3 volts, 14.5 to 15.1 volts. 14,3 to 14.9 volts. 22 amps. 12.7 to 13.3 volts. 9.5 to 11.0 volts. 3.0 to 5.0 amps. 2241 amp. 40/1. 12-volt two-brush, 22 amps. 1,585 r.p.m, at 13.0 volts. 6.0 ohms. 22 to 25 07. (623 to 708 gm.). Belt from crankshaft. Swinging link on dynamo. M418G four-brush inertia type. 15 Ib. ft. (2.1 kg. m.) at 425 amps. 8 Ib. ft. (1.11 kg. m.) at 250 to 270 amps. 32 to 40 02. (907 to 1133 gm.) 13.3: 1 DR.3A single speed. Rack and cable. 008 to .012 2.7 10 3.4 amps. 45 to 50 cycles per minute. 20 to 30mm). 9H 12volt, 3% amps. Lockheed hydraulic. Disc front, drum rear. Lockheed Disc Brake Fluid (Series I) 10% in, (27.3 cm.). Don 55-FF. 203.2 sq. in. (1311 em, 10 in, (25.4 em.) Don 24-FE. 106.8 sq. in. (683.9 cm.*). nfex1 54x Hh in, (240x44.4x4.76 mm.). Ventilated disc, 4-stud fixing. Wire (optional). 43x14. 44Jx14. General Data] GENERAL DATA-~continued (18G/18GA-continued) TYRES Standard: Size = 5.6014 (tubed). Rolling radius 11,65 in. (29.5 cm.) at 30 m.p.h. (48 km.ph). Optional: Size 155-14. ‘TYRE PRESSURES Standard tyres Optional tyres Condition 5.60-14 155-14 Front Rear Front Rear ‘Normal car weight 18 tb,/sq. in. 18 Ib,/sq. in. 21 Ib/sq. in. 24 tb./sq. in. (1.3 kg Joma) (13 kgfem2) (1.5 kgJem.*) (1.7 kg Jem. Sustained speeds in excess 24 Ib./sq. in. 24 Ib./sq. in. 27 Ib /sq. in, 31 Ib./sq. in. of 90 mph. (145 km.p.h.) (1.7 kg fem.2) (1.7 kgJem.?) (1.9 kgfem2) (2.2 kg.fem.2) NOTE: Rear tyre pressures may be increased by 2 Ib./sq. in. (.14 kg./em.*) with advantage when towing with a laden boot. CAPACITIES Fuel tank: Early cars Later cars Cooling system Heater Engine sump Oil cooler Gearbox. Gearbox and overdrive Rearaxle Steering rack .. DIMENSIONS Overall length... Overall length (with over-iders) Overall width... Overall height (hood erected) Ground clearance (minimum) .. Wheelbase. Track: Front (dise wheels) Rear (disc wheels) Front (wire wheels) Rear (wire wheels) WEIGHTS Unladen weight Engine (dry, with clutch) . Gearbox. Rear axle: Disc wheels Wire wheels 10 gallons (45.4 litres, 12 US. gallons). 12 gallons (54 litres, 14 U.S. gallons). 9% pints (5.4 litres, 11.4 US. pints). 4 pint (.28 litre, .6 US. pint). 7h pints (4.26 litres, 9 US. pints). % pint (42 litre, .9 US, pint). 4% pints (2.56 litres, 5.6 U.S. pints). 54 pints (3.36 litres, 6 US. pints). 2% pints (1.28 litres, 2.75 US. pints). 4pint (.19 litre, 39 US. pint). . 12 ft. 84 in. (3.874 m). 12 ft. 946, in. (3.897 m.). 4 ft 1148 in, (1523 em). ~ — 4ft.1Fin, (125.4 em). Sin. (12.7 em). = 7ft.7 in. 231.1 em). 4 ft. 1 in. (124.4 em). 4 ft. 1% in. (125 em). 4 ft. 1% in, (125 em). oft, 1% in, (125 em.). ~~ 1,920 1b. (871 kg). = 358 Ib. (163.3 kg.) approx. == TB Ib. (35.5 kg.) approx. ~ _ LIT# Ib, (53.26 kg.) approx. «123 Ib. (55.79 kg.) approx. MGB. Issue 11. 83910 GENERAL DATA~continued ‘TORQUE WRENCH SETTINGS Engine Main bearing nuts. Flywheel set screws. ‘Gudgeon pin clamp bolt Bigend bolts. Cylinder head nuts Rocker bracket nuts Oil pump to crankcase Sump tocrankease " . Cylinder side cover screws. Second type—deep pressed cover Timing cover—% in, screws Timing cover— in. screws Rear plate— i in. screws Rear plate—# in, screws . Water pump to crankcase Water outlet elbow nuts Rocker cover nuts Manifold nuts Oil filter centre-bolt Clutch to flywheel Carburetter stud nuts” .. Distributor clamp bolt (nut trapped) Distributor clamp nut (bolt trapped) Fan blade fixing screws Rear axle Crown wheel to differential carrier Differential bearing cap. Pinion bearing nut =. Rear brake adjuster securing nuts Bearing retaining nut Rear suspension Rear shock absorber bolts. Front suspension Front shock absorber bolts Brake disc tohub.. Brake calliper mounting Bearing retaining nut Cross-member to body Steering Steering arm bolts Steering wheel nut Steering tie-rod lock nut. Steering lever ball joint nut. Steering universal joint bolt .. Road wheels Road wheel nuts .. MGB. IssueS. 15676 (18G/18GA-continued) 2 TOTD. ft. (9.7 kgm). ee 40 Ib. ft (5.5 kgm.) 25 Ib. ft. (3.4 kg.m.). 35 0.40 Ib. ft. (4.8 to 5.5 km), 45 to 50 Ib. ft. (6.2 to 6.9 kgm.). 25 Ib. ft. 3.4 kgm). 14 Ib. ft. (1.9 kgm). 6b. ft. (8 kgm). 2b. ft. (.28 kg. m.). Sib. ft. (7 kg m.). 6 lb. ft. (8 kg. m.). 14 1b. ft. (.9 kg. m). 20 Ib, ft. (2.8 kg. m.). - .—30Ib. ft. (4.1 kg, m). eon ITIb FL 2.4 kgm). 8 lb. ft. (1.1 kg. m.). 4 Ib. ft. (.56 kg. m.) 15 Ib. ft. (2.1 kg. m). 1S Ib. ft. (2.1 kg. m,) 25 to 30 Ib. ft. (3.4 to 4.1 kg. m.). 2 Ib. ft. (28 kg, m.). 4.16 Ib. ft. (57 kg. m.). 2.5 Ib. ft. (35 kg. m. 73 10.9.3 Ib. ft.(1 to 1.3 kg. m.). 55 to 60 Ib. ft. (7.6 to 8.3 kg. m.). 60 to 65 Ib. ft. (8.3 10 8.9 kg. m.). 135 to 140 Ib. ft. (18.6 to 19.3 kg. m.). 5 to 7 Ib. ft. (69 to .97 kg. m.). 180 Ib. ft. (24.8 kg. m), 55 to 60 Ib. ft. (7.6 to 8.3 kg. m.). 43 to 45 Ib. ft. (5.9 t0 6.2 kg. m.). 40 to 45 Ib. ft. (5.5 to 6.2 kg. m.). 40 to 45 Ib. ft. (5.5 to 6.2 kg. m.). ss 40 to 70Ib. ft. (5.5 to 9.7 kg. m.). we $410.56 Ib, ft. (7.5 to 7.7 kg. m.). 60 to 65 Ib. ft. (8.3 to 8.9 kg. m). 41 t043 Ib. ft. (5.7 to 5.9 kg. m.), 33.3 to 37.5 Ib. ft. (4.6 to 5.2 kg. m.). 34 to 35 Ib. ft. (4.7 to.4.8 kg. m.). 20 to 22 Ib. ft. (2.8 to 3.0kg. m.). 60 to 65 Ib. ft. (8.3 to.9 kg. m.). GENERAL DATA (18GB) ‘The following information is applicable to the 18GB-engined cars and should be used in conjunction with the preceding specification for the 18G/18GA-engined car. ENGINE Type Main bearings Number and type .. Length: Front, centre and rear Intermediate Connecting rods Type .. Big-end bearings Length Pistons Gudgeon pin bore Clearance in cylinder skirt: Top Bottom Gudgeon pin ‘Type .. Fit in piston Diameter (outer) FUEL SYSTEM Carburetter needles. REAR AXLE (GT) ‘Type Ratio > o Differential bearing preload Pinion bearing preload, New collapsible spacer only Pinion bearing preload. Oil seal change spacer collapsed .. Backlash adjustment: Crown wheel Pinion. FRONT SUSPENSION (GT) Spring coil diameter (mean) Free height Number of free coi Static length at load of 1,193 Ib. (541.5 kg.}#20 Ib. (9.1 kg) REAR SUSPENSION (GT) Spring detail Working load (415 Ib. 7 kg.) WHEELS (GT) Size;Disc MGB. Issue 6, 89619 yee 18GB. S$ thin-wall, 1} in, (28.5 mm). Fin, (22.23 mm.).. Angular-split big-end, bushed smallend. 775 to .785 in, (19.68 to 19.94 mm). 8126 to 8129 (20.610 to 20.167 mm). 0012 to .0006 in. (.030 to .015 mm). 0033 to .0021 in. (.080 to .050 mm.). Pully floating 0001 to .00035 in. (.0025 to .007 mm.).. 8124 to 8127 (20.608 to 20.615 mm.). FX (Standard); No. 6 (Rich);No. 21 (Weak). Hypoid, semi-loating 3.909: 1 (11.43). .002 in. (.05 mm.) nip per bearing. 14 to 18 Ib. in. (161 to .207 kg. m.). Adjust to preload, refer Section Ha.4. Shims, Head washer. 3.28 in, (83.3 mm.) 9.14 76in, (23141.6 mm.). 72. 66 in. (168 mm). 510 tb. (321'6 kg). 53x 14in, General Data 11 GENERAL DATA~-continued (18GB-continued) TYRES (GT) Optional: Size and type—Early cars ne Vatercars Standard tyres: Pressures (set cold): Front Rear .. Soe a 8 Sustained speeds in excess of 90 m.p.h. (145 km.ph.): Front Rear .. Optional tyres: Pressures (set cold) Front ee Rear ; ; > 8 = oC Sustained speeds in excess of 90 m.p.h. (145 km.p.h.): Front Rear ; Sooo oe CAPACITIES Rear axle (semi-floating type). wm DIMENSIONS Overall height (GT) .. WEIGHTS Unladen weight (GT) TORQUE WRENCH SETTINGS Rear Axle Half-shaft nut (semifloating axle) Differential bearing cap bolts... sw Crown wheel bolts - Pinion nut, new spacer only Pinion nut, oil seal change Axle shaft nut General Data 12 a 165-14 SP41, 165-14 SP68. 20 Ib./sq. in. (1.4 kg,/em2). 24 Ib,/sq. in. (1.7 kg./om2). 26 Ib//sq. in. (1.8 kg,fem2). 30 1b,/sq. in. (2.1 kg fem2). 21 Ib,/sq. in. (1.5 kg/om2). 24 Ib./sq. in. (1.7 kg,fom2), 28 Ib./sq. in. (2.0 kg./om.). 31 Ib./sq. in. (2.2 kg.fem.). 1% pints (.85 lite, 2 U.S. pints). 4 ft. 1% in. (126.3 em). 2,190 Ib. (993 kg.). 150 tb. ft. (20.75 kg. m.). 50 to 55 Ib. ft. (6.9 to 7.6 kg. m). 60 10 65 Ib. ft. (8.3 to 8.9 kg. m). 180 to 220 Ib. ft. (28.89 to 30.42 kg. m.), Adjust to preload. See Section Ha. 150 Ib. ft. (20.6 kg, m.) and aligned to next split pin hole. MGB. Issue 6. 80619 GENERAL DATA (GHN4/GHD4 CARS, 18GD ENGINE-GHN5/GHDS CARS, 18GG ENGINE) ‘The following information is applicable to the GHN4 and GHD4 series cars fitted with 18GD engines and GHNS/GHDS cars fitted with 18GG engines and should be used in conjunction with the preceding specifications. ENGINE Type Pistons Type. Clearance of skirt in cylinder: Top Bottom Number of rings... Width of ring grooves: Gompresion Oil control .. Piston rings ‘Type: Compression: Top Second Oil control Fitted gap: Compression Oil control .. Width: Compression Oil control... Thickness: Compression: Top Second Gudgeon pin Type. 37 Diameter 2 Fitin: Piston 2 Smallend.. ‘Connecting rods Type. 5 Length between centres Locking method big-end COOLING SYSTEM Fan belt: Width Length Thickness. Tension ‘Thermostat: Normal .. Hot climates Cold climates FUEL SYSTEM Carburetter needles... MGB. Issue 3. 80619 18GD-18GG. Aluminium solid skirt, three rings. .0021 to .0033 in. (.053 to .084 mm.). .006 to .0012 in. (.015 to .030 mm). Three; 2 compression. 1 oil control. .064 to-.065 in. (1.625 to 1.651 mm.) .1578 to .1588 in. (4.01 to 4.033 mm). Plain, sintered alloy. Tapered, sintered alloy~marked ‘TOP’. ‘Two chrome-faced rings with expander, Apex. 012 to .022 in. (305 to .600 mm). .015 to .045 in. (38 to 1.14 mm). .0615 to .0625 in. (1.56 to 1.59 mm.) 152 to .158 in. (3.86 to 4.01 mm). 124 to .127 in. (3.14 to 3.22 mm). 104 to .111 in. (2.64 to 2.81 mm): Press fit in connecting rod. 8125 to 8127 in, (20.63 to 20.64 mm.) Hand push fit at 16°C. (60°F.). 12 Ib. ft. (1.7 kg. m.) minimum using 18G 1150 and adaptor type C. Horizontal split big-end, solid small-end. 6.5 in, (165.1 mm). Multi-sided nut. Bin. (11.9 mm). 354 in. (90.2 em.) at Fin. width equivalent, #in. (10.7 mm). ¥ in. (128 mm.) movement at midway of longest run 82° C. (180° F). 74° C. (165° F.). 88° C. (190° F). FX (Standard), No. 6 (Rich), GZ (Weak). General Data 13 r GENERAL DATA~continued (GHN4/GHD4 CARS, 18GD ENGINE-GHNS/GHDS CARS, 18GG ENGINE)-continued CLUTCH Fluid Lockheed Disc Brake Fluid (Series 329). GEARBOX AND OVERDRIVE ‘Number of forward gears... 4. Synchromesh .. 5 All forward gears. Gearbox ratios: Reverse 3.095 : 1. First 3.4421 Second 21671 Third 1.382:1 Fourth 1.000 : 1 Overdrive: Type Laycock LH. Ratio 82:1. Overall gear ratios: Reverse 12.098: 1 First 13.45: 1. Second 8.47: 1. OVERDRIVE Third 44331 Fourth... ee 2 Top gear speed per 1,000 r-p.m.: Standard (29 km.p.h).. Overdrive .. 22 mp.h. 35 km.ph), Speedometer gear ratio: Standard 10: 26. Overdrive 8:21 ‘Synchromesh hub springs: Free length 72 in. (18.3 mm.) Fitted length Load at fitted length First and third speed gear end-float Second gear end-float Laygear end-float 385 in. (9.8 mm.) 5.5 to 6 Ib. (2.5 to 2.7 kg.) 005 to .008 in. (.13 to.20 mm.). £005 to .008 in. (.13 to.20 mm,).. .002 to .003 in. (.05 to .08 mm.) AUTOMATIC GEARBOX Torque converter ratio 22:10:41 Gearbox ratios: Reverse 2.09: 1 First 23931 Second 14531. Top . oe 1.00: 1 Overall gear ratio (converter at 1: 1): Reverse 8.1721 First. 9.3421. Second 5.668 : 1. Top 3.909 : 1 Speedometer gear ratio : 10: 26. REAR AXLE Type Hypoid; semi-floating. Ratio 3.909 : 1 (11/43). Differential bearing preload Pinion bearing preload Backlash adjustment: Crown wheel Pinion General Data 14 .002 in. (.05 mm.) nip per bearing, Refer to Section Ha. Shims. Head washer. MGB. Issue 3. 80619 GENERAL DATA—continued (GHN4/GHD4 CARS, 18GD ENGINE—GHNS/GHDS CARS, + 18GG ENGINE)—continued ELECTRICAL System Batteries ‘Type (two 6-volt) Capacity: 10-hour rate 20-hour rate Plates per cell. Electrolyte to fill one cell Control box Type Voltage setting Alternator Type. Output at 14 volts and 6,000 r.p.m. Maximum permissible rotor speed Pulley ratio—alternator/crankshaft Stator phases Rotor poles Rotor winding resistance Brush length (new) Brush spring tension Starter Type Light running current Lock torque Torque at 1,000 r.p.m. Solenoid: Closing coil resistance Hold-on coil resistance Brush spring tension Starter motor relay Type Winding resistance Bobbin core to underside of armature air gap: Contacts open Contacts closed Cut-in voltage Drop-off voltage ‘Wiper motor ‘Type Armature end-float Light running current: Normal speed High speed Light running speed: Normal speed High speed BRAKES Brake fluid MGB. Issue 5. 85699 12-volt, NEGATIVE earth. (Later cars) Lucas BT9E or BTZ9E Lucas CASE. 51 amp.-hour 53. amp-hour. 58 amp.-hour 60 amp.-hour. 9 9. 1 pint (570 c.c., 1-2 US. pints). ATR Electronic. 14:3 to 14-7 volts at 5,000 p.m. 18GD engine 18GG engine Lucas 16AC Lucas 16ACR 34 amps. data as \6AC. 12,500 r.p.m. 1-795 21. 3. 12. 4:33 ohms £5% at 20° C. (68° F.). + in. (126 mm). 7 to 10 02, (198-283 gm.) with brush face flush with brush box. Lucas M418G Pre-engaged. 70 amp. at 5,800 to 6,500 r.p.m. 17 Ib. ft. 2:35 kg. m.) at 465 amps. 7b. ft. (97 kg. m.) at 260 amps. “13 to “15 ohm. “63 to -73 ohm. 36 07. (1-02 kg.). Lucas Model 6RA-33243. 76 ohms. 0-030 40-005 in, (0:76-0:13 mm). 0-010+0-003 in. (025008 mm.). 40 to 7-5 volts. 5 volts (maximum). Lucas, 14W (two-speed). -004 to -008 in. (-1 to 21 mm.). 1-5 amp. 2-0 amp. 46 to 52 rpm. 60 to 70 r.p.m. Lockheed Disc Brake Fluid (Series 329). General Data 15 GENERAL DATA—continued (GHN4/GHD4 CARS, 18GD ENGINE—GHNS/GHDS CARS, 18GG ENGINE)—continued CAPACITIES Gearbox Gearbox and overdrive Automatic gearbox Rear axle TYRE PRESSURES 5+ pints (3 litres, 6 U.S. 6 pints (3-4 litres, 7 U.S. pints). 104 pints (6 litres, 12-7 U.S. pints), ints). 14 pints (-85 litres, 2 USS. pints). Tourer 5-60—14S, 155SR—14 Cross-ply tyres Radial-ply tyres Front Rear Front Rear ‘Normal car weight 19 Ib,/sq. in. 2 1b./sq. in 21 Ib,/sq. in. 24 Ib,/sq. in. (1-34 kg, /om.t) (1°55 kg,/om2) (1-48 kg,/om.4) (1-69 kg.fem} Maximum weight 19 Ib,/sq. in. 24 Ib./sq. in 21 Ib,/sq. in. 26 Ib. in. (1-34 kg.fem.2 (1-69 kg,/em.3) (1-48 kg.Jem.3) (183 kgfom.3) GT Normal car weight 20 Ib./sq. in. Maximum weight 20 Ib./sq. in. (14 kg,fom.2) (1-4 kg, fom.2) 24 Ib./sq. in. (1-69 kg./em2) 26 Ib./sq. i (1-83 kg/m) ‘Tyre size 165SR—14 Pressures as Tourer It is recommended that for sustained speeds at or near the maximum the above tyre pressures are increased by 6 Ib./sq. in. (42 kg.jem.). WEIGHTS Total weight Distribution Front ‘Rear Tourer or Tourer or Tourer or Kerbside Including full 2,303 16. | 2.4011. | 1,1271. | 1,1621b. | 1,1761b. | 1,2391b. fuel tank, all (1044 kg.) | (1088 kg.) | (512 kg.) | (627 kg) | 534k) | (562 ke) optional extras and accessories Normal Kerbside weight | 2,6531b. | 2,751. | 1.23510. | 1,2691b. | 1,418tb. | 1,482.6. including driver, | (1203 kg.) } (1248 kg.) | (560 kg.) | (576 kg.) | (643 ke.) | (672 ke.) passenger and 50 Ib. (22 kg.) Juggage ‘Maximum Normal weight 2,7531b. | 2,8511b. | 14,1931, | 123116. | 1,560. | 1,6201b. including tow- (1249 kg.) | (1293 kg.) | (S41 ke.) | (558 kg.) | (708 kg.) | (735 ke.) bar hitch load ‘Maximum permissible 1,680 16. | 1,680 1b. towing weight (762 kg) | (762 kg.) Maximum towbar hitch load 1001b. | 1001b. (45 kg.) | 45 kg) Data 16 MGB. Issue 5, 85609 GENERAL DATA—continued (GHN4/GHD4 CARS, 18GD ENGINE~GHNS/GHDS CARS, 18GG ENGINE)—continued WHEELS ‘Type: Pressed disc Pressed spoked Wire (optional) TORQUE WRENCH SETTINGS Automatic gearbox Converter to drive plate bolts : ‘Transmission case to converter housing bolts Extension housing to transmission case bolts Oil pan to gearbox bolts Front servo bolts Rear servo bolts Pump adaptor to housing screw Pump adaptor to housing bolts Pump adaptor to transmission case bolts Manual shaft locknut Pressure adaptor plug Drain plug... - Upper valve body to lower valve body screws Lower valve body to upper valve body screws Oil tube and end plate to valve bodies screws Valve bodies to transmission case bolts Cam bracket screws Governor to counter-weight screws . Governor cover-plate screws Front servo adjusting screw locknut Rear servo adjusting screw locknut Starter inhibitor switch locknut Downshift cable adaptor bolts Filler tube connector sleeve to transmission case Filler tube to connector sleeve nut Stone-guard screws Driving flange nut Centre support bolts General Stiffnut to cross-member mounting bolt Gearbox remote control cover to tunnel Hydraulic brake pipe connection— in. UNF. Hydraulic brake pipe connection—f in. UNF. Steering-wheel nut—f, in. UNF. Steering-wheel nut—# in. UNF. Electrical Alternator shaft nut MGB. Issue 4. 85699 43x14 (Tourer) SU F/HX 14 43x 14 (60-spoke) sJx14 (GT) 25 to 30 Ib, ft. (3-46 to 415 kg. m.). 8 to 13 Ib, ft. (I-I to 1-8 kg. m) 8 to 13 Ib. ft. (Il to 1-8 kg. m). 8 to 13 Ib. fi. (1-1 to 1-8 kg. m). 8 to 13 Ib. ft. (I-l to 1-8 kg. m). 13 to 27 Ib. ft. (I'8 to 3-73 kg. m), 2 to 3 Ib. ft. (28 to 41 kg. m.). 17 to 32 Ib. ft. (2:35 to 4-43 kg. m.). 8 to 18:5 Ib. ft. (I-1 to 255 kg. m.). 70.9 Ib. ft. (97 to 1:24 kg. m.). 4 t0 5 Ib. ft. (35 to “69 kg. m.), 8 to 10 Ib. ft. (I-1 to 1-38 kg. m.). 20 to 30 Ib. in. (-23 to -345 kg. m). 20 to 30 Ib. in. (-23 to 345 kg. m.). 20 to 30 Ib. in. (-23 to -345 kg. m)). 4:5 10.9 Ib. fi. (61 to 1:24 kg. m.) 20 to 40 Ib. in, (-23 to -46 kg. m.). 4 to 5 Ib. ft. (55 to -69 kg. m). 20 to 48 Ib. in, (-23 to “552 kg. m.). 15 to 20 Ib. ft, (2:07 to 2-77 kg. m.). 25 to 30 Ib. fi. (3-46 to 415 kg. m.) 4 to 6 Ib. ft. (55 to -83 kg. m.) 8 to 9 Ib. ft. (Iel to 1-24 kg. m.). 20 to 30 Ib. ft. (2:76 to 4-15 kg. m.). 17 to 18 Ib. ft. (2:35 to 2-49 kg. m. 17 to 19 Ib. in. (196 to 219 kg. m): 55 to 60 Ib. ft. (7-6 to 8:3 kg. m.) 10 to 18 Ib. ft. (1-38 to 2-49 kg. m.) 44 to 46 Ib. ft. (6.08 to 6:36 kg. m.). 755 to 9-5 Ib. ft. (1-04 to 1-31 kg. m.). 5 to 7 Ib. fi. (69 to -96 kg. m.). 7 to 10 Ib. ft. (-96 to 1-38 kg. m.). 27 to 29 Ib. ft. (3-73 to 4-01 kg. m.). 41 to 43 Ib. ft. (5-66 to 5-94 kg. m.). 25 to 30 Ib, ft. (3-46 to 4-15 kg. m.. General Data 17 GENERAL DATA ‘The information given in this section refers specifically to service operations on, or affected by, equipment fitted to the MGB (GHNS/GHN4 and GHDS/GHD4) in conformity with local and territorial requirements, and must be used in conjunction with the preceding DATA. ENGINE Type (1967-69) Type (1969-70) Type (1969-70) Type (1970-1) Type (1971-2) Type (1971-2) Type (1972-4) Type (1972-4) Jing, adjusting and tuning the above type engines and cars fitted with Vehicle Emi 18GF (EEC). 18GH (EEC, Carburetter crankcase ventilation). 18GJ (EEC, ELC, Carburetter crankcase ventilation). 18GK (EEC, ELC). 18V 584Z (EEC, ELC—Non overdrive) 18V 585Z (EEC, ELC—Overdrive). 18V 672Z (EEC, ELC—Non overdrive) 18V 673Z (EEC, ELC—Overdrive). Abbreviations: EEC, Exhaust Emission Control; ELC, Evaporative Loss Control. ion Control Equipment must be carried out in accordance with the instructions given in Workshop Manual Supplement AKD 4957. FUEL SYSTEM Fuel tank capacity (Engine types 18GJ and 18GK) . Carburetter needle: 18GF 18GH-18GJ 18GK 18V 584Z and 18V 585Z 18V 672Z and 18V 673Z DISTRIBUTOR Make/type. . Serial number: 18GF 18GH-18GJ 18GK I8V 584Z and 18V 585Z I8V 672Z and 18V 673Z TORQUE WRENCH SETTINGS Interior mirror special screw . Steering-column top fixing bolts Steering-column universal joint bolts Steering-wheel nut Steering-whee! nut—J in, UNF. Master cylinder port adaptors “Master cylinder reservoir fixing bolts, Brake pressure failure switch (nylon) =. Brake pressure failure switch assembly end plug Hydraulic brake pipe connection—@ in. UNF. Hydraulic brake pipe connection—y in. UNF. General Data 18 12 USS. gallons (45-4 litres). Lucas 25D4. 40897, 41155. 41339, 41370, 41491 5 Ib. in, (058 kg. m.). 12 to 17 Ib. ft (1-66 to 2:35 kg. m). 20 to 22 Ib. ft. (28 to 3-04 kg. m.). 36 to 38 Ib. ft. (4-98 to 5-26 kg. m). 27 to 29 Ib. ft. (3-73 to 4-00 kg. m,). 33 Ib. ft. (4-56 kg. m). 5 Ib. ft, (69 kg. m.) 15 Ib. in, (-173 kg. m.), 200 Ib. in. (2-3 kg. m). 5 to 7 Ib, ft. (-69 to -96 kg. m.). 7 to 10 Ib. ft, (96 to 1-38 kg. m.). MGB. Issue 4. 85699 GENERAL DATA (GHNS/GHDS CARS, 18V type ENGINE) ‘The following information is applicable to the GHNS and GHDS series cars from Car No. 258001 fitted with the 18V type engine, and should be used in conjunction with the preceding specifications. ENGINE ‘Type: Synchromesh gearbox Synchromesh gearbox wi Automatic transmission overdrive. Valves Inlet valve: Seat angle Head diameter Stem diameter Stem to guide clearance... Later cars: Head diameter. sw Stemdiameter 2 Stem to guide clearance ws Valve spring Free length .. Fitted length Load at fitted length Load at top of lift ELECTRICAL Starter motor Type Brush spring tension Minimum brush length Minimum commutator thickness Lock torque Torque at 1,000 r.p.m. .. Light running current Maximum armature end-float Solenoid: Closing (series) winding resistan Hold-on (shunt) winding resistance FRONT SUSPENSION—From Car No. Free height Bilenc Static length at load of 1,030420 Ib. (46749 kg.) Static length at load of 1,193420 Ib. (54149 kg) No.offreecoils REAR SUSPENSION ‘Number of spring leaves Width of springleaves Gauge of leaves: Ist, 2nd, 3rd. 4th, Sth, 6th .. Workingload Ls MGB. Issue 4. 91427 18V 581F—18V 581Y—18V 779F—18V 846F 18V 582F—18V 582Y—18V 780F—18V 847F 18V 583F—18V 583Y. 45%, 1.625 to 1.630 in, (41.27 t0 41.40 mm). 0.3429 to 0.3434 in, (8.70 to8.72 mm.). 0.0008 to 0.0018 in. (0.020 to 0.046 mm.) INLET EXHAUST 1.562 to 1.567 in 1.343 to 1.348 in (39.67 to 39.80 mm). (34.11 t0 34.23 mm.) 0.3429 to 0.3434 in. 0.3423 t0 0.3428 in. (8.10108.72mm.). (8.69 10 70 mm). 0,0007 to 0.0019 in. 0.0013 to 0.0025 in (0.020 10 0.045 mm.). (0.03 to 0.06 mm.) 1.92 in, (48.77 mm). 1.44 in. (36.58 mm.). 82 Ib. (37.2 kg). 142 Ib. (644 kg). Lucas 2M 100 Pre-engaged. 36 oz. (1.02 kg.). Fin. (9.5 mm,). 0.140 in, (3.5 mm.). 144 lb. ft. (2.02 kg. m.) with 463 amps. 7.3 Ib. ft. (1.02 kg. m.) with 300 amps. 40 amp. at 6,000 r.p.m. (approx.) 0.010 in, (0.25 mm.). 0.25 to 0.27 ohm. 0.76 to 0.80 ohm. Tourer Tourer Gr 293446. Later cars. 296 196. 10.2040.06 in. 10.20 in. nominal. 9.32#%¢in. (259.0841.5 mm). (259.08 mm.)._ (236.7341.6 mm.). 7240 7.44 in. -- (187.70 mm). (188.98 mm.) — 6.84 in, (173.74 mm). 15. 9. 72. 6 interleaving between 1/2, 2/3. 1.76 in, (44.7 mm). “mg 0.2187 + 0.006 in. (5.55 * 0.152 mm.) : 0.1875 + 0.006 in. (4.75 # 0.152 mm.) 510 to 540 Ibf. (231 to 245 kgf.) General Data 19 GENERAL DATA (GHNS/GHDS CARS, 18V type ENGINE) TORQUE WRENCH SETTINGS Engine Bigend nuts (12 sided) .. Crankshaft pulley nut. Camshaft nut - Carburetter-stud nuts .. Spark plugs... Oil pipe banjo Oil release valve—dome nut Front plate~ 4 in. screws Rear plate~ & in, screws Rear engine mounting bolt 33 Ibf. ft. (4.5 kgf. m.). 70 Ibf. ft. (9.6 kgf. m.) 65 Ibf. ft. (8.9 kgf. m.) 15 bf. ft. (2.1 kgf. m,). 18 Ibf. ft. (2.5 kgf. m,). 37 Ibf. ft. maximum (5.1 kgf. m.) 43 Ibf. ft. (5.9 kgf. m.) 20 Ibf. ft. (2.8 kgf. m.), 30 Ibf. ft. (4.1 kgf. m.), 38 Ibf. ft. (5.22 kgf. m.). WEIGHTS Distribution | Loading condition Total weight Front Rear Tower | GT | Tourer | Gr | Tourer | Gr | Kerbside Including full fuel tank 2.39416 | 2.4461 | 121616 | 1.1981 | 1,1781b | 1,248 1b | and all optional extras, (1088 kg) | (1110 kg) | (551 kg) | (543 ke) | (534 kg) | (566 ke) Normal Kerbside weight including | 2,6941b | 2,7461 | 1,3321b | 131410 | 1,3621b | 1,4321b driver and passenger (1223 kg) | (1245 kg) | (604 kg) | (596 ke) | (618 kg) | (649 kg) Gross Maximum weight condition | 2,8141b | 2,866 1b | 1,285 1b | 1,2671b | 1,5291b | 1,599 1b refer to note below (1277 kg) | (1301 kg) | (583 kg) | (574 kg) | (693 ke) | (725 ke) Maximum permissible towing weight 1,6801b | 1,680 1b (762 kg) | (762 kg) Maximum towbar hitch load 1001b | 10016 (45 ke) | (45 kg) Maximum roof rack load S01b (23 kg) NOTE: Due consideration must be given to the overall weight when fully loading the car. Any loads carried on a luggage rack ‘or downward load from a towing hitch must also be included in the maximum loading, (GHNS/GHDS CARS FROM CAR No. 410002) CAPACITIES Fuel tank Coolingsystem Cooling system with heater + ee 12 gallons (54.5 litres, 14.4 US. gallons) ee 1D pints (6.6 litres, 13.8 US. gallons) ee 12 pints (6.8 litres, 14.4 US. gallons) DIMENSIONS Track: Frost www 3 4 ft VA in (124.7 em) Rear ee AFL I (126.4 em) ral Data 20 MGB. Issue 4. 91427 ENGINE TUNING DATA 18G, 18GA, AND 18GB ENGINES ENGINE Type. . Displacement S46 Firing order bBo oG Compression ratio: H. Le. Compression pressure: H.C. LC. Idle speed Valve rocker clearance Static ignition timing: H.C... Le. Stroboscopic ignition timing: H.C... Le. ‘Timing mark location. DISTRIBUTOR Make/Type Contact breaker gap Contact spring tension Rotation of rotor Dwell angle Centrifugal advance Crankshaft degrees/speed (vacuum pipe disconnected) Vacuum advance Starts Finishes o Total crankshaft degrees IGNITION COIL, Make/Type . Resistance: Primary .. SPARKING PLUGS Make/Type Gap CARBURETTERS Make/Type . Jet =e Needle: 18G and 18GA engines... 18GB engine Piston spring ELECTRICAL Dynamo... Battery. Volts/Polarity .. Starter Control unit MGB. Issue2. 25729 18G, 18GA, 18GB. 109.8 cu. in. (1798 c.c.). 1,3,4,2. 88:1. 8.0: 1 160 ib./sq. in. (11.25 kg,/om.), 130 Ib./sq. in. (9.15 kg./em.2). 500 rp.m. 015 in, (.38 mm.) set cold. 10°B.T.D.C. 8 BIDE. 14° BT.D.C. at 600 r.p.m. 12° B.T.D.C. at 600 r.p.m. Pointer on timing case, notch on crankshaft pulley. Lucas/25D4. .014 to .016 in, (.35 to 40 mm.) 18 to 24 o7. (510 to 680 gm.) Anti-clockwise. 60°83" SERIAL NUMBER ‘SERIAL NUMBER 40897 (H.C.) 40916 (L.C.) 6° at 600 r.p.m. 6° at 600 r-p.m. 6° at 700 r.p.m. 8° at 800 r.p.m. 9° at 900 r.p.n. 9 at 1,000 r.p.m. 15° at 1,600 rp.m. 18° at 3,000 1 20° at 2,200 r.p.m 24° at 4,400 rp.m, 5 in, Hg. (127 mm. Hg). 4 in. Hg (101.6 mm. Hg). 13 in, Hg (330.2 mm. Hg). 12 in, Hg (304.8 mm. Hg). 20°42". 162°, Lucas/HA12. 3.1 to 3.5 ohms at 20°C. (68° F.). Champion/N9Y. 024 to .026 in. (,625 to .66 mm.). S.U,JHS4. 090 in, (2.2 mm.). No. $ (Std.), No. 6 (Rich), No. 21 (Weak). FX (Std.), No. 6 (Rich), No. 21 (Weak). Red Lucas C40/1. Lucas BT9E or BTZ9E. 12-volt/Positive earth. Lucas M418G Inertia-type. Lucas RB.340. Engine Tuning Data 1 ’ NGINE TUNING DATA 18GD AND 18GG ENGINES ENGINE Type. ee I8GD=18G6. Displacement 109.8 cu. in. (1798 e..). Firing order Compression ratio: H.C. Le Compression pressure: H.C. : 160 tb,/sq. in. (11.25 kg./em2). Le. - 130 tb./sq. in. (9.15 kg.fem.2). Idle speed . 500 r.p.m. Valve rocker clearance O15 in. (38 mm.) set cold. Static ignition timing: H.C = 10°B.T.D.C. Le. 8° BTD.C Stroboscopic ignition timing: H.C... 14° B.T.D.C. at 600 r.-p.m. LQ ew = 12°BTD.C. at 600 r.p.m. Timing mark location Pointer on timing case, notch on crankshaft pulley. DISTRIBUTOR Make/Type Lucas/25D4, .014 to .016 in. (35 to 40mm.) So 18 to 24 oz. (510 to 680 gm. ew Anti-clockwise Contact breaker gap .. Contact spring tension Rotation of rotor Dwell angle - - ee 607", Centrifugal advance SERIAL NUMBER SERIAL NUMBER 40897 (H.C.) 40916 (L.C.) Crankshaft degrees/Speed (vacuum pipe disconnected) 4° at 600 r.p.m. 6° at 600 rpm. 6° at 700 r.pan. 8° at 800 rpm. 9° at 900 r.p.m, 9° at 1,000 r.p.m 15° at 1,600 r.p.n. 18° at 3,000 p.m. 20° at 2,200 rpm. 24° at 4,400 rp.m. Vacuum advance Stats se we Sin Hg 4in. Hg (127 mm. Hg). (101.6 mm. Hg). Finishes ee AB in. Hg 12 in. Hg (330.2 mm. Hg). (304.8 mm. Hg). Total crankshaft degrees. we 208828, 1642". IGNITION COLL, Make/Type >> oe oo Lucas/HA12. Resistance: Primary’. boo aa 3.1 to 3.5 ohims at 20°C, (68° F.). SPARKING PLUGS Make/Type es Champion /NOY. Gap ee O24 10.026 (.625 to .66 mm). CARBURETTERS Make/Type ~ — SU/HS4, Keto - .090 in. (2.2 mm.). Needle. . Standard, FX; Rich, No. 5; Weak, GZ. Piston spring. : Red. ELECTRICAL Alternator 18GD, Lucas 16AC, 18GG, Lucas 16ACR. Battery Lucas CASE early cars, Lucas BT9E or BTZ9E. Volts/Polarity.. 12-volt/NEGATIVE earth. ~ Lucas M418G Pre-engaged. Lucas 4TR (18GD only). MGB. Issue 2. 25729 ENGINE TUNING DATA 18GF, 18GH, 18GK and 18V S84Z, 18V 585Z 18V 6722 and 18V 673Z ENGINES Servicing, adjusting and tuning the above type engines and cars fitted with Vehicle Emission Control Equipment must be carried out in accordance with the instructions given in Workshop Manual Supplement AKD 4957. MGB. Ise 3, 63910 Engine Tuning Data 3 ENGINE TUNING DATA 18V 581Y, 18V 582Y, AND 18V 583Y ENGINES ENGINE Type . 1sv. Displacement .. 109.8 cu, in, (1798 c.c.). Firing order 1,3,4,2 Compression ratio: 5 a 9.031. so . 8.021 Cranking pressure Nominal 170 Ibf./sq. in. (11.95 kgf./om.) at 275 pan, Idle speed. 750 t0 800 p.m, Valve rocker clearance: Set cold... ONS in, (38 mm.) Set hot - ~ O13 in, (33 mm.) Static ignition timing: H.C. ~ » 10°BT.D.C. Li 10° B.T.D. Stroboscopic ignition timing: H.C. 13° BT-D.C. at 600 r.p.m. Le. 13° B. 600 r.p.m. Pointer on timing case, notch on crankshaft pulley. ‘Timing mark location DISTRIBUTOR Make/Type Contact breaker gap .. Contact spring tension Rotation of rotor oe Lucas/25D4, 014 to .016 in. (.35 to.40 mm), 18 to 24 07. (510 to 680 gm.). Anti-clockwise. Dwell angle - : 60°43", Centrifugal advance SERIAL NUMBER SERIAL NUMBER 41288 (H.C) 41290 (L.C) Crankshaft degrees/Speed (vacuum pipe disconnected)... Oto 6° at 600r-pm. —_—0 to.6° at 600 r.p.m. 4to9 at 700rpm. 6 to 10° at 800 p.m. Tito 11? at 900r.p.m. 7 to 11° at 1,000 r.p.m. 13 to 17° at 1,600 r.p.m. 16 to 20° at 3,000 r.p.n. 18 to 22° at 2,200 rpm. 22 to 26° at 4,400 p.m. ‘Vacuum advance Starts ee Si Hg 4in. Hg (127 mm. Hg). (101.6 mm. Hg). Finhes 0 : 13 in, Hg 12 in, Hg (330.2 mm. Hg). (304.8 mm. Hg). Total crankshaft degrees. ee 20782, 16742". IGNITION COIL Make/Type 2 we ‘Lucas/HA12. Resistance: Primary .. - 3.1 to 3.5 ohms at 20°C. (68° F.). SPARKING PLUGS Make/Type ee ‘Champion/N9Y. Gp 024 to .026 (.625 to .66 mm.). CARBURETTERS Make/Type : SU/HIFS, Jet 090 in, (2.2 mm). Needle . AAU, Piston spring Red. ELECTRICAL Alternator. mm Las 1GACR. Battery Lucas BT9E, BIZ9E, CA9E, SG9E or Exide 3XCK9L. Volts/Polarity .. : 12 volt[NEGATIVE earth. Starter ao Lucas 2M100 Preengaged. MGB. Issue 3. 86842 Engine Tuning Data 5 ENGINE TUNING DATA 18V ENGINES-To European emission control requirements (ECE 15) ENGINE Type Displacement. Firing order Compression ratio Cranking pressure : Valve rocker clearance: set cold Idle speed. Fast idle speed ‘Stroboscopic ignition timing Static ignition timing Timing mark location DISTRIBUTOR Make/Type Contact breaker gap Contact spring tension Rotation of rotor Dwell angle Serial number .. Centrifugal advance Crankshaft degrees/Speed (vacuum pipe disconnected) ‘Vacuum advance Starts Finishes, . Total crankshaft degrees IGNITION COIL Make/Type Resistance: Primary ae SPARKING PLUGS Make/Type Gap CARBURETTERS Make/Type Specification Jet no Needle. Piston spring. EXHAUST EMISSION Exhaust gas analyser reading at engine idle speed Engine Tuning Data 6 18V. 109.8 cu. in, (1798 c. 1,3,4,2 9.0 Nominal 170 to 190 Ibf./sq. in. (12 to 13.4 kgf./em.’). -015 in. (.38 mm.) 750 t.p.m. 1,100 to 1,200 r.p.m. 15° B-T.D.C. at 1,000 r.p.m. SBTD.C. Pointer on timing case, notch on crankshaft pulley. Lucas/25D4. .014 t0 016 in. (35 to 40 mm.) 18 to 24 oz. (510 to 680 gm.) Anticlockwise. 60°43". 41032. 0 to 3° at 600 r.p.m. 0 to 4° at 700 r.p.m. 2 to Pat 900 r.p.m 10 to 14° at 1,600 r.p.m, 17 to 21° at 2,200 p.m. 3 in. Hg. (76 mm. Hg). 8 in. Hg. (203 mm. Hg.). 14429, Lucas/HA 12 3.1 10 3.5 ohms at 20°C. (68° F.). Champion/N9Y. 024 to .026 (625 to .66 mm.) SU/HIF4. AUD 434. -090 in. (2.2 mm.). AAU. Red. 3 to 4.5% CO. MGB. Issue 3. 96842 ENGINE TUNING DATA 18V 779F and 18V 780F ENGINE~To European emission control requirements (ECE 15) ENGINE Type. Displacement Firing order. Compression ratio . Cranking pressure. Valve rocker clearance: set cold. Idle speed =. Fast idle speed. Stroboscopic ignition timing Static ignition timing Timing mark location 1 ew DISTRIBUTOR Make/Type Contact breaker gap... Contact spring tension Rotation of rotor Dwell angle Serial number .. Centrifugal advance Crankshaft degrees/Speed (vacuum pipe disconnected). Vacuum advance Stats Finishes 5 2 Total crankshaft degrees IGNITION COIL Make/Type Resistance: Primary. Consumption .. SPARKING PLUGS Make/Type Gap CARBURETTERS Make/Type . Specification. Jett Needle ston spring. ” EXHAUST EMISSION Exhaust gas analyser reading at engine idle speed MGB. Issue 2, 89961 I8v. 109.8 cu. in. (1798 c..). 1,3,4,2 9.021 Nominal 170 Ibffin® (11.95 kgf/em*) at 275 r.p.m 0.015 in, (0.38 mm.). 850 rp.m. 1,100 to 1,200 r.p.m. 11°B.T.D01—UIEKE— DHEA “FE poses 18771 pur S8EbH ‘ON vesowroys, “£5 yes POISE “EE suriug 01 da) apmn8 anea=Prowys —“¢] ‘pms—anN “zs 4JeUs say203 FODaIaNOP—HUSEA “Ze “Bonds oaqearen09. “1 “pat apurjéo ut pms—uIe|d—r9WSEN “TS “moses Aue00}—Yoo1—26Id “TE nyea—tauuy—8undg “ty wogie—lausem uIor “05 ayeys 199201-Bune201-MaDs “OF aarea—saino-Suuds “OT soyem—19pNO—MoRI “6 -wo19s funsnfpe iadde.—10N “62 ‘asnmps-a4rrA “6 saBuo] noiok—oootd osu “Bp jaddn—Sunsnipe—noi9g“8z aR-aAEA “8 Smd—foa1s—I99C] “Lp say90 NEUEN “LT ‘AY O} Moga YaPINO IDEAS “L upyieds—mia 9p pousng-anqea-s0y008 “92 Tayoesq~s04901-AU0}~pMIs “9 Fnid—says4q “Sb ujoeds 19ys01—Funds“§Z oyeIq—!AY9OI-HOYS—PMS_°S ssoq rentuisurs eUioN—Feld “pp yous oypor—ured—royoeG “+ ‘jou no-Bmg“p mans—fuds—ope “Eb ‘yeys ioypor—padder—ay>eig“¢z anes ysneun9—apIND °€ ‘prow repunds 01 rmd—KOI§ “Zh saypor aafea—pamaios—nld ZZ nye yaqt—apingy syed Buryunig soypem 1wIog “Ip ssayoos anyea—ueyd—Aing “1 opin unin Ayquiosse peay Jopunié “1 wondi2seq oN. vwondiss0q oN wonduosaq oN SLNANOdNOD GVIH YAGNITAD IHL OL AT Aq Issue 4. 60230 MGB. A THE ENGINE, Refitting the cylinder head Make sure that the surfaces of both the cylinder head and ihe cylinder block are clean, It will be noticed that the cylinder head gasket is marked ‘FRONT’ and ‘TOP? to assist in replacing it correctly with the copper side uppermost. Having slipped the gasket over the studs, next lower the cylinder head into position, Replace the vacuum control pipe clip and fit the seven cylinder head external nuts finger tight Replace the push-rods in the pdsitions from which they were taken. Replace the rocker assembly and securing nuts finger tight. Tighten the 11 cylinder head nuts, a turn at a time, in the order given in Fig. A.2. Finally, tighten the four rocker assembly nuts. Reassembly continues in the reverse order to the dismantling procedure, ‘Switch on the ignition and check the fuel system for leaks. Start the engine and run it until the normal working temperature is reached. Remove the rocker cover and check the valve clearances (see Section A.7). Replace the rocker cover and connect the breather hose. Section A.7 VALVE GEAR AND VALVES Removing and replacing valves Remove the cylinder head as in Section A.6 Remove the valve circlip. Compress the double valve springs, using Service tool 18G45, and remove the two valve cotters. Release the valve springs and remove the compressor, valve spring cap, shroud (carly engines only), inner and outer springs, and bottom collar. —_— OHS Fig. Aa Parts of the valve assembly, showing the valve, cotters, circlip, bottom collar, double valve springs, shroud (early engines only), packing ring, and spring cap. The inset shows ‘the valve packing ring fitted correctly at the bottom of the cotter groove below the cotters AS Fig. AS Grinding in a valve, using Service tool 18629. Occasionally lift the valve off its seat to spread the grinding paste evenly lover the seat and valve face Remove the valve packing ring from the cotter groove and withdraw the valve from the guide. Keep the valves in their relative positions when removed from the head to ensure replacement in their original valve guides. The exhaust valve heads are concave and are smaller in diameter than the inlet valves. To replace the valves place each valve into its guide and fit the bottom collars, inner and outer valve springs, shrouds (early engines only), and caps. Compress the valve springs and push a new synthetic rubber packing ring over the tip of the valve stem down to the bottom of the cotter groove (see Fig. AA). Refit the two valve cotters and remove tne compressor. Replace the valve circlip. NOTE.—Do not fit old valve packing rings, or oil sealing ‘may suffer. The rings are fitted more easily if they have been soaked in clean engine oil for a short period before use. Removing and replacing valve guides Rest the cylinder head with its machined face downwards on a clean surface and drive the valve guide downwards into the combustion space with a suitable-sized drift. This should take the form of a hardened steel punch 4 in, (14 mm.) in diameter and not less than 4 in, (10 cm.) in length, with a locating spigot ‘& in. (7.9 mm.) diameter machined on one end for a length of 1 in. (2.5 cm.) to engage the bore of the guide. When fitting new valve guides these should be driven in from the top of the cylinder head. The valve guides must be inserted with the end having the largest chamfer at the top. the valve guides should be driven into the combustion spaces until they are the, required height above the machined surface of the valve spring seating (see Fig. A.6 and ‘GENERAL DATA’), MGB. Issue 4. 60230 THE ENGINE A 4874 Fig. AG ‘When fitting valve guides they must be driven in until they are the required height above the machined surface of the valve spring seating (A) Grinding and testing valves and seatings Each valve must be cleaned thoroughly and carefully examined for pitting. Valves in a pitted condition should be refaced with a suitable grinder or new valves should be fitted. Pitted or uneven valve seats must be refaced using a grinder or cutter, care being taken that only the minimum quantity of metal necessary to restore the seat is removed. If the seats are very worn or damaged refer to Section A.28. When grinding a valve onto its seating the valve face should be smeared lightly with fine- or mediumgrade carborundum paste and then lapped in with a suction anton 25, 18G 25 A, 18G 174 B, 18G 25 C, 18G 27, 18G 28, 18G 281A, 18G 28 B, 18G 28 C, and 18G 174 D MGB. Iswe7. 80619 grinder (Service tool 18G 29). Avoid the use of excessive quantities of grinding paste and see that it remains in the region of the valve seating only. A light coil spring placed under the valve head will assist considerably in the process of grinding. The valve should be ground to its seat with a semi-totary motion and ‘occasionally allowed to rise by the pressure of the light coil spring. This assists in spreading the paste evenly over the valve face and seat. It is necessary to carry out the grinding operation until a dull, even, mat surface, free from blemish, is produced on the valve seat and valve face On completion, the valve seat and ports should be cleaned thoroughly with a rag soaked in paraffin (kerosene), dried, and then thoroughly cleaned by compressed air. The valves should be washed in paraffin (kerosene) and all traces of grinding paste removed. Fit a new valve packing ring when refitting the valves (see Fig. A.4). Checking valve timing Set No. 1 cylinder inlet valve to .055 in, (1.4 mm.) clearance with the engine cold, and then turn the engine until the valve is about to open. Fig. AB The notch in the pulley approaching the T.D.C. position for pistons 1 and 4, The inset shows the timing scale $° marks ‘The indicating notch in the flange of the crankshaft pulley should then be opposite the longest of the three pointers on the timing cover, i. the valve should be about to open at TDC. and No. 4 piston will be at T.D.C. on its compression stroke, Do not omit to reset the inlet valve clearance to the recommended clearance (see ‘GENERAL DATA’) when the timing check has been completed. The clearance of .055 in. (1.4 mm.) is necessary to bring the opening position of the valve to T D.C. It is not possible to check the valve timing accurately with the normal running valve clearance. ‘Adjusting valve rocker clearances If the engine is to give its best performance and the valves are to retain their maximum useful life. it is essential to Ag THE CYLINDER BLOCK COMPONENTS. | A.10 MGB. Issue 7. 80619 “ated yuoyj 0} ey2e19 Suyunow autBus— “maton Sunzds— eg, ssroyuer9 0} 94d Bug unoUl—m9I9§ aed Suyunow—soysea.-rm0¢ “Supunow auyfua-aimg woafpat—una “prepums—sadeios—Bury -prepunis—pig pue puz—vopseiduos-s8ury -prepums-dor—uotsasduo>—Sury ‘OH prpueis-siquosse wos wondussaq_ ee ze te 08 62 8 ue st we ai on dey esp s94s0 4 ‘yo01g s9puyyso—uresp—dey, “duind sorem-femog, a1eyd Supunow xoqiea8-jamoq deo Suysroq wreur 35 pute su03}—2u10¢ 59 ayeysuueS—20urT “pms Burraq urew—1n ‘pros Surze9q, sued sa dno Burv0q ure pras “Busnoy ajpurds ‘a JaWOYDR~prIs adh ueIS— prs uondiaseq zw 17 0 6 at U1 31 st aa a tu en SLNANOdWOO ¥907E YAGNITAD FHL OL ADL ‘woys-di pris 1 0ys—proy sopuyso—pmag Suol—pey s9punlgo- pms Snyd pamaras—says0q, -pamorss-ajou rong “ pea} yo auosuay uTeK>—Beng “eyou 1u0n aaj jones Wont “ajou no arvoyursa—1ade.—So1g Araqye8 yo aseoquess—Snyg *982e1—yojom—Bn1g All MGB. Isue4, 69615 A THE ENGINE Fig. A9 ‘The method of adjusting the vaive rocker clearance and the rect position for measuring it maintain the correct valve clearance. Accordingly it is recommended that the clearance be checked at regular intervals and any necessary adjustments made. For the correct valve rocker clearance refer to “GENERAL DATA’. The engine has been designed to operate with this clearance and no departure from it is permissible. Provision for adjusting the valve clearance is made in the rocker arm by an adjustable screw and locknut. ‘The rocker adjusting screw is released by slackening the hexagon locknut with a spanner while holding the screw against rotation with a screwdriver. The valve clearance can then be set by carefully rotating the rocker screw while checking the clearance with a feeler gauge. This screw is then relocked by tightening the hexagon locknut while again holding the screw against rotation. It is important to note that while the clearance is being set the tappet of the valve being operated upon is on the back of its cam, i. opposite to the peak. As this cannot be observed accurately, the rocker adjustment is more easily carried out in the following order, and this also avoids turning the engine over more than is necessary Adjust No. 1 rocker with No. & valve fully open. No.3» N06 yo» m No.5, No4 yn ns 2 N02 yy NOT ny nw » No.8 yy NOL y ym » No 6 NOS yn yy NO 4 yy NOS yyw NOT yy NO2 ye yw Section AS TAPPETS Remove the carburetters (see Section D) and the rocker cover. Remove the manifolds (see Section A.4) Disconnect the high-tension leads from the sparking plugs. AA2 Remove the rocker assembly as in Section A.S and withdraw the push-rods, keeping them in their relative positions to ensure their replacement onto the same tappets. Release the breather pipe, remove the tappet covers, and lift out the tappets, also keeping them in their relative positions. New tappets should be fitted by selective assembly so that they just fall into their guides under their own weight when lubricated. Assembly is a reversal of the above procedure, but care should be taken to see that the tappet cover joints are oiltight and that the rockers are adjusted to give the correct valve clearance. Section A.9 DECARBONIZING Remove the cylinder head as described in Section A.6. Withdraw the valves as described in Section A.7. Remove the cylinder head gasket and plug the waterways with a clean rag, If special equipment is not available for decarbonizing it will be necessary to scrape the carbon deposit from the piston crowns, cylinder block, and cylinder head, using a blunt scraper. ‘A ting of carbon should be left round the periphery of the piston crown, and the rim of carbon round the top of the cylinder bore should not be touched. To facilitate this an old piston ring can be sprung into the bore so that it rests on top of the piston. ‘The cylinder head is next given attention. The sparking plugs must be cleaned and adjusted. Clean off the carbon deposit from the valve stems, valve ports, and combus spaces of the cylinder head, Remove all traces of carbon dust with compressed air or by the vigorous use of a tyre pump and then thoroughly clean with paraffin (kerosene) and dry off, Fig. A.10 Unscrew the camshaft chain wheel securing nut with spanner 18G 980 MGB. Iswe4, 69615 THE ENGINE A Fig. ALL ‘Crank the engine until the timing dimples (1) and (2) are ‘opposite each other before removing the timing chain and chain wheels. The chain tensioner is retracted into the unloaded position by turning the Allen key (3) ina clockwise diection Fit a new cylinder head gasket when replacing the head if the old has been damaged, noting that the gasket is marked to indicate the top face and the front end. Section A.10 VALVE TIMING GEAR AND CHAIN TENSIONER ‘Timing cain cover Drain the cooling system and remove the radiator-Section C7. Slacken the dynamo or alternator securing bolts and remove the fan belt. On 18GB and later engines, remove the bolts securing the steeringrack to the body and ease the rack assembly forward sufficiently to allow the crankshaft pulley to be withdrawn, Fig. A12 Replacing the oil seal in the crankcase front cover using Service tool 18G 134 and adaptor 18G 134 BD MGB. Issued. 15676 Unlock the crankshaft pulley retaining bolt, unscrew the bolt using tool 18G 98 A and withdraw the pulley. Unscrew the timing cover retaining bolts and remove the cover. Use a new gasket when refitting the timing cover. The felt washer or oil seal (later cars) in the timing cover should also be renewed if necessary. Ensure that the oil thrower behind the crankshaft pulley is fitted with the face marked ‘F* away from the engine. Replacement of the timing cover is a reversal of the above procedure. When refitting the cover it is important to ensure that the seal, rubber or felt, is centralized on the crankshaft, and a Service tool (18G 1046) is available for the purpose, NOTE.-The early type front cover and oil thrower must be used together. When refitting, ensure that the oil thrower is fitted with its concave side facing away from the engine, Use Service tool 18G 3 to centralize the rubber seal on the Install the securing serews finger tight and centralize the ‘crankcase front cover with the crankshaft, using Service tool 186 1046 If a rubber seal is fitted fill the annular groove between the lips with grease. Lubricate the hub of the pulley and push it into the seal, at the same time turning it to avoid damaging the felt or the lips of a rubber seal. Slide the pulley onto the shaft with the keyway in line with the key in the crankshaft. Turn the cover as necessary to align the set serew holes with those in the crankcase, taking care not to strain the cover against the flexibility of the seal. Insert the set screws and tighten up. Refit and tighten the pulley securing screw. Timing chain Remove the bottom plug from the chain tensioner, insert a 4 in. (3.18 mm) Allen key in the cylinder, and turn the key clockwise until the rubber slipper head is fully retracted and locked behind the limit peg. AB A THE ENGINE Unscrew and remove the two securing screws and then remove the tensioner and its backplate. Unlock and remove the camshaft chain wheel nut and remove the nut and lock washer. Note that the locating tag on the lock washer fits into the keyway of the camshaft chain wheel. The camshaft and crankshaft chain wheels may now be removed, together with the timing chain, by easing each wheel forward, a fraction at a time, with suitable smaller levers. ‘As the crankshaft gear wheel is withdrawn care must be taken not to lose the gear packing washers immediately behind it, When reassembling replace the same number of washers as was found when dismantling, unless new camshaft or crankshaft components have been fitted which will disturb the alignments of the two gear wheels. To determine the thickness of washers required place a straight edge across the sides of the camshaft wheel teeth and measure with a feeler gauge the gap between the straightedge and the crankshaft gear. Subtract .00S in. (-13 mm.) from the feeter gauge reading and add the resultant thickness of crankshaft gear packing washers. When replacing the timing chain and gears, set the crankshaft with its keyway at T.D.C., and the camshaft with its keyway approximately at the one o'clock position when seen from the front. Assemble the gears into the timing chain with the two marks on the gear wheels opposite to each other, as in Fig. A.11. Keeping the gears in this position, engage the crankshaft gear Keyway with the key on the crankshaft and rotate the camshaft until the camshaft gear keyway and key are aligned. Push the gears onto the shafts as far as they will go and secure the camshaft gear with the lock washer and nut. Replace the oil thrower, with the face marked ‘F? or the concave side (early-type) away from the engine, and the remaining components. Fig. AS ‘Checking the chain wheel alignment with a straight-edge and feeler gauge 708 Fig. A.1S “The chain tensioner components Timing chain tensioner Remove the tensioner assembly from the block as described above. Withdraw the plunger and slipper assembly from the tensioner body and engage the lower end of the cylinder with the Allen key. Tum the key clockwise, holding the key and plunger securely until the cylinder and spring are released from inside the plunger. Clean the components in petrol, and blow out the oil holes in the slipper and spigot. Check the bore in the adjuster body for ovality. If the ovality is greater than .003 in. (.076 mm.) when measured on diameters near the mouth of the bore, then a complete new adjuster must be fitted. If within the acceptable limit, then fit a new slipper head and cylinder assembly in the existing body. It isimportant that dirt is not allowed to enter the adjuster, so ensure that all parts are clean before reassembly. When the tensioner is in operation and the engine is running, oil from the lubrication system enters the spigot ‘on the back face under pressure and lubricates the bearing surface through a hole in the slipper pad. The pad is held ‘against the chain by the coil spring. Should the chain stretch with use, the slipper plunger rises and the limiting pag, bearing on the top of the helical slot, MGB. Isue4. 15676 THE ENGINE A rotates the cylinder until the next recess in the lower edge of the slot comes into line with the limiting peg and prevents the plunger returning to its original position and allowing the timing chain to become slack again. When reassembling, insert the spring in the plunger and place the cylinder on the other end of the spring. Compress the spring until the cylinder enters the plunger bore, engaging the helical slot with the peg in the plunger. Hold the assembly compressed in this position and engage the Allen key. Turn the cylinder clockwise until the end of the cylinder is below the peg and the spring is held compressed. Withdraw the key and insert the plunger assembly in the body. Replace the backplate and secure the assembly to the cylinder block. ‘After refitting the tensioner, check the slipper head for freedom of movement and ensure that it does not bind on the backplate when it is moved in the body. When the timing chain is in position the tensioner is released for operation by inserting the key and turning it clockwise until the slipper head moves forward under spring pressure against the chain. Do not attempt to tum the key anti-clockwise or force the slipper head into the chain by external pressure. Secure the bolts with the locking plate, replace the bottom plug, and lock with a tab washer. Section A.11 SUMP AND STRAINER Drain the radiator and disconnect the hoses, drain the sump, and then release the engine front mounting bolts. Sling the engine and lift it sufficiently to gain access to the front sump bolts. Remove all the bolts and withdraw the sump from the crankcase. To remove the oil strainer remove the two bolts securing it to the pump cover. The strainer may be dismantled for cleaning by removing the centrenut and bolt and the two delivery pipe flange bolts. Note that there is a locating tongue on the side of the cover which must be positioned correctly when replacing. Remember also to replace the distance tube. Clean out the sump and strainer with paraffin (kerosene) and a stiff brush; never use rag. When refitting the sump to the engine give particular attention to the sealing gaskets for the crankcase face and the two oil seal packings for the crankcase which fit into recesses in the crankcase. If the gaskets are in good condition and have not been damaged during removal of the sump they may be used again, but it is always advisable to fit new ones. Before fitting new gaskets remove all traces of the old ones from the sump and crankcase faces. Smear the faces of the crankcase joint with grease and fit the two halves of the large gasket. Lift the sump into position on the crankcase, insert the 19 bolts, and tighten them evenly. MGB. Issue 3. 1329 Refit the engine to its mountings and the hoses to the radiator. Refill the radiator and the sump with coolant and fresh oil respectively. Section A.12 OIL PUMP Two bolts secure the oil pump cover and three studs secure the pump to the crankcase. Unscrew the stud nuts and remove the pump and drive shaft, When refitting the pump use a new joint washer, Unscrew the two securing screws and carefully withdraw the cover, which is located on the base of the oil pump body by two dowels. Withdraw the outer rotor, and the inner rotor complete with oil pump shaft, from the pump body. Thoroughly clean all parts in paraffin (Kerosene) and inspect them for wear. The rotor end-float {nd lobe clearances should be checked as follows: 1. Install the rotors in the pump body, place a straightedge across the joint face of the pump body, and measure the clearance between the top face of the rotors and the under side of the straight-edge. The clearance should not exceed .005 in. (.127 mm.). In cases where the clearance is excessive this may be remedied by removing the two cover locating dowels, and carefully lapping the joint face of the pump body. 2. Check the diametrical clearance between the outer rotor and the rotor pocket in the pump body. If this, exceeds .010 in. (.254 mm.) and cannot be reme by the renewal of either the pump body or the rotors, then the pump assembly should be renewed, 3. With the rotors installed in the pump body measure the clearance between the rotor lobes when they are in the positions shown in Fig. A.17. If the clearance is in excess of .006 in. (.152 mm.) the rotors must be renewed. Fig. Al6 Checking the oil pump rotor endfloat, which should not exceed .005 in. (127 mm) AS A THE ENGINE Fig, AIT The lobe clearance should not exceed .006 in, (.152 mm.) ‘when the oil pump rotors are in the positions illustrated Reassembly is a reversal of the dismantling procedure noting the following points: 1, Lubricate all parts with clean engine oil, 2. Ensure that the outer rotor is installed in the pump body with its chamfered end at the driving end of the rotor pocket in the pump body. 3. After reassembling check the pump for freedom of action, Section A.13 MAIN AND BIG-END BEARINGS Unless the bearing journals are badly worn the big-end bearings may be renewed without removing the crankshaft. To renew the main bearings it is necessary to withdraw the crankshaft, Liners are used for both the main and the big-end bearings, which are of the shimless type and therefore non-adjustable. Big-end bearings Drain the engine oil and remove the sump as in Section AA As the bearings are of the shimless type it is essential that no attempt should be made to adjust bearings which are wom, Always fit new bearings in place of worn parts. If the crankshaft journals are found to be in a worn condition it is advisable to fit a Service crankshaft, complete with main and big-end bearings, as supplied by the Factory. Both the big-end and main bearing liners are located in the bearing housings by @ small tag on one side of each half-bearing; it should be noted that the bearings are fitted so that the tags come on the same joint edge of the bearing housing, although on opposite corners. To detach the big-end bearings, bend down the locking strips so that the bolts may be removed. Remove the connecting rod caps and extract the bearings. Care should be taken to see that the bearing journals are thoroughly cleaned before installing new bearings. No scraping is required, as the bearings are machined to give the correct diametrical clearance of .0016 in. (.04 mm.). A16 Main bearings Remove the engine from the car and remove the flywheel and clutch, the timing chain (Section A.10), the sump and strainer (Section A.11) and the rear engine mounting plate. Note that a thrust washer is fitted on each side of the centre main bearing to take the crankshaft end-thrust. These thrust washers each consist of two semi-circular halves, one having a lug which is located in a recess in the detachable half of the bearing and the other being plain. Before refitting the crankshaft check the end-float (see “GENERAL DATA’) and select and fit new upper and ower thrust washers as required. The washers are available in standard thickness and .003 in. (.076 mm.) oversize. Remove the two bolts and locking plate securing the front ‘main bearing cap to the engine front bearer plate Remove the main bearing cap retaining nuts and locking plates (early engines) or the self-locking nuts and plain ‘washers (later engines). ‘When fitting new bearings no scraping is required as the bearings are machined to give the correct diametrical clearance of .001 to .0027 in. (.025 to .067 mm.). In the case of a ‘run’ bearing it is always essential to clean Out thoroughly all the oilways in the crankshaft and block, wash out the engine sump with paraffin (kerosene), and clean the oil pump and sump strainer to ensure that no Particles of metal are left anywhere in the lubricating system, The rear main bearing cap horizontal joint surfaces should be thoroughly cleaned and lightly covered with Hylomar Jointing Compound before the cap is fitted to the cylinder block. This will ensure a perfect oil seal when the cap is bolted down to the block. Refit each main bearing and cap, refitting the thrust washers in their correct Positions at the centre main bearing with the oil grooves away from the bearing. The connecting rod bigend bearing locating tags (A) and ‘rooves (B). The figures (C) indicate the cylinder from which the rod and eap were removed MGB. Issue 3, 1329 THE ENGINE A Lubricate the main bearing cap joint seat liberally with oi before refitting. When refitting the bearing caps on early engines use a new locking plate to lock the nuts; on later engines check that the self-locking nuts lock to the stud threads efficiently. Tighten the bearing cap nuts to the torque figure given in ‘GENERAL DATA’. Section A.14 PISTONS AND CONNECTING RODS Remove the cylinder head as in Section A.6. Drain and remove the sump and oil strainer as in Section A.11 The pistons and connecting rods must be withdrawn from the top of the cylinder block. Unlock and remove the big-end bolts and remove the bearing caps, Release the connecting rod from the crankshaft, Withdraw the piston and connecting rod from the top of the cylinder block and refit the bearing cap. The big-end bearing caps are offset. When used parts are replaced after dismantling it is essential that they should be fitted in their original positions. In order to ensure this, mark the caps and connecting rods on their sides which are fitted together with the number of the cylinder from which each was taken, Replacement of the piston and connecting rod is a direct reversal of the above, but the piston ring gaps should be set at 90°'to each other. It is essential that the connecting rod and piston assemblies should be replaced in their own bores and fitted the same way round, ie. with the gudgeon pin clamp screw on the camshaft side of the engine. The piston crowns are marked SFRONT" to assist correct assembly to the connecting rods. Refit the big-end bearings in their original positions. Pistons and gudgeon pins (18G/18GA) ‘The gudgeon pin is rigidly held in the split little-end of the connecting rod by a clamp bolt engaging the central groove apne Fig, A.19 ‘Assembly positions of the connecting rods, showing the offsets MGB. Issue 4. 1329 Zz; - he. A.20 Method of loosning and'ightening the gudgton pin clamp Bott c18G/186A) Before the piston and gudgeon pin can be dismantled from the connecting rod it is necessary to remove the clamp screw. To enable the assembly to be held in a vice for this ‘operation without damage holding plugs should be inserted in each end of the gudgeon pin. ‘Unscrew the gudgeon pin clamp and remove it completely. Push out the gudgeon pin, Reassembly is a reversal of the above. IMPORTANT.—Attention must be given to the following points when assembling the piston to the connecting rod: 1. That the piston is fitted the correct way round on the connecting rod. The crown of the piston is marked “FRONT” to dssist this, and the connecting rod is fitted with the gudgeon pin clamp screw on the camshaft side That the gudgeon pin is positioned in the connecting rod so that its groove is in line with the clamp screw hole. 3. That the clamp screw spring washer has sufficient tension. 4. That the clamp screw will pass readily into its hole and screw freely into the threaded portion of the little-end, and also that it will hold firmly onto the spring washer. ‘A certain amount of selective assembly must be used when fitting new gudgeon pins. They must be a thumb-push fit for three-quarters of their travel, to be finally tapped in with a raw-hide mallet, This operation should be carried out with the piston and gudgeon pin cold, Piston rings If no special piston ring expander is available, use a piece of thin steel such as a smoothly ground hacksaw blade or a disused .020 in. (50 mm.) feeler gauge. Raise one end of the ring out of its groove. Insert the steel strip between the ring and the piston, Rotate the strip around the piston, applying slight upward pressure to the + AAT MGB. Issue4. 1329 A18 co ee sea “+1 ‘ges: wy sea yeysqurio—Suppoed—sope A “LT Prepueys-ureui—Bueoq —-] aie ene mat augues-seo ana -6¢ ee aoe oni oe “prepens-posuzs0veo-Saiea “5 i MOQ—Yoo]—TYysE “SE “aa195—Yo]—JaysE yy — “OT "MO1I—YIO]—IOYSEM i surwonms on euAT-ned “6 ee ee i ovt—O-29 “EE ‘Baeso} yeusuns-oima “81 —SapuNM ypu Z ON despuE poLSuyDoUNeD “2 | ee Fn ee SLNANOdWOD TVNUALNI ANIONG FHL OL ATX i i | i AIS Iseue 3.1329 GB. A THE ENGINE none Fig. A2t ‘Checking the piston ring to groove clearance raised portion of the ring until it rests on the land above the ring grooves. It can then be eased off the piston. Do not remove or replace the rings over the piston skirt, but always over the top of the piston. Before fitting new rings clean the grooves in the piston to remove any carbon deposit, Care must be taken not to remove any metal or sideplay between the ring and the groove will result, with consequent excessive oil consumption and loss of gas-tightness. When refitting the rings note that the second and third compression rings are tapered and marked with the letter ‘T’ (top) for correct reassembly. Examination Thoroughly clean the bearing shells and the faces of the connecting rods and the bearing caps. Examine the shells for wear, pitting, or cracking, and renew them if necessary. New shells are finished with thé correct diametrical clearances and do not require bedding in, Blow the oil passages in the connecting rods with an air blast and ensure that they are free from obstruction, Check the connecting rods for twist and bow as shown in Fig. A.22. Do not file the caps or rods. Check the ring to groove clearance as shown in Fig. A.21 New rings must be tested in the cylinder bore to ensure that the ends do not butt together. The best way to do this is to insert the piston approximately 1 in. (2.54 em.) into the cylinder bore, push the ring down onto the top of the piston, and hold it there in order to keep it square with the bore, The correct ring gap is .008 to .013 in. (20 to .33 mm). Section A.15 PISTON SIZES AND CYLINDER BORES In addition to the standard pistons there is a range of oversize pistons available for service purposes. Oversize pistons are marked with the actual oversize dimensions enclosed in an ellipse. A piston stamped .020 is only suitable for a bore .020 in. (.508 mm.) larger than the Checking a piston ring gap standard bore; similarly, pistons with other markings are only suitable for the oversize bore indicated. The piston markings indicate the actual bore size to which they must be fitted, the requisite running clearance being allowed for in the machining. After reboring an engine, or whenever fitting pistons differing in size from those removed during dismantling, ensure that the size of the piston fitted is stamped clearly on the top of the cylinder block alongside the appropriate cylinder bore.” Section A.16 CAMSHAFT Disconnect the battery. Remove the inlet and exhaust manifold assembly (see Section A.4). Remove the push-rods and take out the tappets (see Section AB). MGB. Issue3. 1329 ‘THE ENGINE A Remove the timing cover, timing chain, and gears (see Section A.7). Disconnect the suction advance unit pipe from the distributor and take out the two bolts with flat washers securing the distributor to the housing. Do not slacken the clamping plate bolt or the ignition timing setting will be lost. Remove the distributor assembly Sections A.25 and A.26. Remove the sump, oil pump, and oil pump drive shaft (see Section A.11). If a drive-type tachometer is fitted, disconnect the drive, remove the securing nuts and washers and withdraw the drive gear. Take out the three set screws and shakeproof washers which secure the camshaft locating plate to the cylinder block and withdraw the camshaft. Before reassembly, which is a reversal of the dismantling procedure, assemble the camshaft retaining plate and the chain wheel to the camshaft, and check the camshaft end-float against the dimensions given in the ‘GENERAL DATA’ section by measuring the clearance between the retaining plate and the thrust face of the camshaft front journal, If the end-float is excessive the retaining plate should be renewed. Section A.17 RENEWING THE CAMSHAFT BEARINGS While the camshaft is removed it is advisable to check the bearing liners for damage and wear. If these are not in good condition they must be removed and new ones fitted, aps308 Fig. A.24 Checking the camshaft end-float MGB. Issue 5. 15676 Fig. A.28 Replacing the camshaft contre bearing liner, using Service tool 18G 124 A with adaptors 18G 124 H and 18G 124 C 1. Wing nut 2. Body 3. Adaptor 18G 124 H. 4 Centre screw. 5. Adaptor 186 124 C. ‘The old bearings can be punched out. The new ones must be tapped into position. These bearings are easily damaged and the use of Service tool 18G 124 A is recommended. 6. Bearing liner. T. Large ‘C’ washer. 8. Slotted washer 9. Tommy-bar This tool comprises a body with built-in thrust race, screw wing nut, stop plate, ‘C’ washer and handle, and must be used in conjunction with the following adaptors: 18G 124 B, 18G 124, 18G 124 F, 18G 124 H. Removing the front and rear liners Insert the small end of the adaptor 18G 124 F into the camshaft front liner from the inside of the cylinder block, thread the body of the tool onto the centre screw, and pass the screw through the adaptor from the front of the block. Place the slotted washer on the flat at the rear of the centre serew and insert the tommy-bar into the centre screw ind the slotted washer. ‘Tighten up the wing nut to withdraw the worn liner. ‘The rear liner is withdrawn by the same method, using the adaptor 18G 124 B and withdrawing the liner from the rear of the block. Removing the centre liner Insert the stepped pilot adaptor 18G 124 H into the camshaft liner front bore from the inside of the block and the adaptor 18G 124 C into the centre liner from the rear, small end first With the body of the tool positioned on the centre screw, pass the screw through the pilot adaptor and the adaptor in the centre liner. Place the slotted washer on the flat at the rear of the centre screw and insert the tommy-bar into the screw behind the slotted washer. ‘Tighten up the wing nut to withdraw the liner. Replacing the front and rear liners Place the new liner on the smallest diameter of the adaptor 18G 124 F and insert the adaptor into the camshaft front A21 A THE ENGINE < agone wage gan Fig. A.26 Showing the cutters and pilots positioned for reaming the front and rear liners. Inset are the pilots and cutter positioned for reaming the centre liner A. Position No. 6 liner bore from the inside of the block, largest diameter first. Line up the oil holes in the liner and the cylinder block and make certain that they remain correctly positioned during the whole operation, Thread the body of the tool onto the centre screw and pass the screw through the adaptor located in the front liner from the front of the block. Position the larger of the two °C’ washers on the centre sorew with the cut-away portion turned away from the butt joint of the liner; this joint must be covered by the washer. Place the slotted washer on the flat at the rear of the centre serew and insert the tommy-bar into the screw behind the slotted washer. Tighten the wing nut to pull the liner squarely into position. The rear liner is replaced by the same method, using the adaptor 18G 124 B and pulling the liner into position from the rear of the block. Replacing the centre liner Insert the stepped pilot adaptor into the camshaft front liner from the inside of the block. Place a new centre liner on the small end of the adaptor 18G 124 C and position the adaptor in the centre liner bore from the rear, largest diameter first. Ensure that the oil holes in the liner and the cylinder block are lined up and remain so during the whole operation, With the body of the tool positioned on the centre screw insert the screw through the pilot adaptor and the adaptor in the centre liner bore. Position the larger of the two ‘C’ washers on the centre serew with the cut-away portion turned away from the butt joints of the liner; this joint must be covered by the washer. Place the slotted washer and the tommy-bar in the centre screw and tighten up the wing nut to pull the liner into Position, A22 = B. Position No. 10 C. Position No. 9 Reaming the liners Before the camshaft can be reassembled the liners must be reamed in line in order to obtain the correct clearance between the shaft journals and their bearings. For this Purpose use tool 18G 123 A, which comprises an arbor with tommy-bar and Allen key, and must be used with the following adaptors: 18G 123 B, 18G 123 E, 18G 123 F, 18G 123 L, 18G 123 T, 18G 123 AB, 18G 123 AC, 18G 123 AD. Reaming the front and rear liners Insert the taper pilots 18G 123 AB and 18G 123 AC into the centre and rear liners respectively Place the plain pilot 18G 123 L on the arbor, followed by the cutter 18G 123 E. Pass the arbor through the front liner and the pilot located in the centre liner. Place the cutter 18G 123 B on the arbor and push the arbor through the taper on the rear liner. Secure the cutters and pilots in their respective positions (see illustration), ensuring that the cutter locating pins are engaged in the correct numbered hole provided in the arbor. The cutter for the front liner will cut first with the arbor piloting in the centre and rear liners. Clear away the swarf frequently during the operation. The cutter for the rear liner will follow with the arbor piloting in the front and centre liners, Clear away all the swarf before the plain pilot is allowed to enter the front liner. When the cut in the rear liner is finished free the cutters and withdraw the arbor. Reaming the centre liner Set up for the second part of the operation by inserting the pilots 18G 123 T and 18G 123 AD in the front and rear liners. Pass the arbor through the pilot in the front liner and place the cutter for the centre liner on the arbor. Push the arbor MGB. IssueS. 15676 THE ENGIN! through the centre liner and the pilot located in the rear liner. Secure the cutter and pilots in position, ensuring that the locating pin of the cutter engages the correct numbered hole in the arbor. Ream the centre liner, release the cutter, and withdraw the arbor. IMPORTANT.-It is essential that the cutter flutes are kept clear of swarf at all times during the cutting operation, preferably with air-blast equipment. The cutter should be withdrawn from the liner half-way through the cut and the swarf removed from the cutter and the liner. Feed the reamer very slowly, and keep the cutters dry. The arbors should be lightly lubricated before assembling the cutters and pilots. Section A.18 REMOVING AND REPLACING THE CRANKSHAFT ‘(Engine Out of Car) Take off the clutch and the flywheel (see Section A.19), the timing cover, the timing wheels and chain (see Section A.10), the sump and the oil pump strainer (see Section A.11), and the rear engine mounting plate. Remove the big-end bearing cap and then take off the main bearing caps (see Section A.13). Mark each big-end bearing cap and bearing to ensure that it is reassembled to the correct journal, taking care, in the case of the bearings, that they are not damaged or distorted when marking. Punches should not be used for this Purpose. Lift the crankshaft out of the bearings. Replacement of the crankshaft is a reversal of the above operations. Before replacing the crankshaft thoroughly clean out all oilways. Check the condition of the rear engine mounting plate oil seal (18GB engines) and renew if necessary. Note that each main bearing cap is stamped with a common number which is also stamped on the centre web of the crankease near the main bearing. Section A.19 REMOVING AND REPLACING THE FLYWHEEL (Engine Out of Car) Remove the clutch by unscrewing the six bolts and spring washers securing it to the flywheel. Release the bolts a tum at a time to avoid distortion of the cover flange. Three dowels locate the clutch cover on the flywheel Unlock and remove the six nuts and three lock plates which secure the flywheel to the crankshaft and remove the flywheel, When replacing the flywheel ensure that the 1 and 4 timing mark on the periphery of the flywheel is in line with and on the same side as the first and fourth throws of the crankshaft. MGB. Issued. 15676 Fig. A.27 Withdrawing the front main bearing cap, using Service tool 18G 42 A and adaptor 186 42 B To assist correct location of the flywheel the depression in the crankshaft flange face is stamped with a similar timing ‘mark which should be in line with the one on the flywheel periphery. To release the special flywheel bolts the engine sump and rear main bearing cap must also be removed. Section A.20 FITTING FLYWHEEL STARTER RINGS. To remove the old starter ring from the flywheel flange split the ring gear with a cold chisel, taking care not to damage the flywheel. Make certain that the bore of the new rings and its mating surface on the flywheel are free from burrs and are perfectly clean. To fit the new ring it must be heated to a temperature of 300 to 400°C. (572 to 752 F.), indicated by a light-blue surface colour. If this temperature is exceeded the temper of the teeth will be affected. The use of a thermostatically controlled furnace is recommended. Place the heated ring ‘on the flywheel with the lead of the ring teeth facing the flywheel register. The expansion will allow the ring to be fitted without force by pressing or tapping it lightly until the ring is hard against its register. This operation should be followed by natural cooling, when the ‘shrink fit” will be permanently established and no further treatment required. Section A.21 REMOVING AND REFITTING THE ENGINE AND POWER UNIT It is possible to remove the engine only from the car, but it is recommended that the engine and gearbox are removed together as a complete assembly thus avoiding possible damage to the clutch when separating and refitting the gearbox to the engine within the confines of the car. A23 THE ENGINE MOUNTINGS Supjunows sea: fjquiosse 1oquuaUess01) craquigur a 4 sso 01 fupunow zear-tned aH “FE Suds-s0¥sey “91 uidsopi0N “0s -meor-auiuo—Bununow “CE “mois 10530 “$1 uid.0} fonds “6 J curd porkeis—inN “Ze i und 10j oryd—s0usem “BF 1oyoug : and pordns fuuds—10450H, “16 urs 011940819 09 pue SapUNON— MOIS PL i udu “LP porkns-ulg “Of soyoerq 03 fununow—ION “ET Sununow auhuo tuna “9 ua coquarxe sto! xoqres-posopinows—wnd “62 yoyse1q 01 Suunou-Butsds—s04p0H “ZT ; Lds—iyseH, “sp 1 “pOrATIS—INN “BT “W'T-Sununow ouius yuosy—saqqny “11 snquoussom 01 wypeIq—MeIS “Fp sat ‘pos-Aeys—Guysds—s9ysem LT “Wusununow ourdua ywory—19qqny “OL } reno|-Sunow auf 1295-10981 “Ch i ne a ‘porseis 20} any OUI “97 Smids—rousem “6 t addn-opunou oufuo rar-1oN9eH “Zh ‘pyna-aima “Sz Spord orieyoeia-aang-§ sroi-Suyunow oufog “1p . -ponsns—sonin“¥0 Sunder “L Sununou sufue—reyoe39 011409 “OF voce -ourfue-porsng “¢z snows 201309 soqqns W-T-furjsed-aied “6 aunds-sowse “TC H-T-aimd fununour on ypeIq-NaDS —°s usds—sope LG yoyeng— wag “12 “ma 0)70N“p | oq 0} fununow wo1-mog “LE * poréns auue—iapad “0c WA-and Smunow o1 ypeIa-AaNs “E i -raquousssox9 0} Sununow Zeo1—InN“9E furds—sone “61 WT Bonunou sufua wwoH}-seyIEIG“Z aqui -sso19 oy Sujunour seor-sunds—1ySeR “SE -auriy oy soquiowrsso:2—no!9§ “BT “yx Sonunow suu wox}-Ae}INE“T wonduoea oN won daoso on wondussea on SONILNNOW ANIONA IHL OL AD } A25 15676 Issue 6. MGB. A THE ENGINE Removing the power unit ALL MODELS 1. Disconnect the batteries. 2. Remove the bonnet—Section R.9. 3. Drain the oil from the engine and gearbox. 4. Drain the coolant from the engine and radiator. 5. Disconnect the oil cooler and oil pressure gauge pipes from the engine. 6. Disconnect the top and bottom radiator hoses from the engine. 7. Remove the oil cooler securing bolts. 8. Remove the radiator and diaphragm assembly—Section C.6~complete with oil cooler and pipes. 9. Disconnect the wiring from the dynamo or alternator and the distributor. 10, Detach the leads from the sparking plugs and remove the distributor cap. 11, Disconnect the heater hoses and control cable. 12. Disconnect the thermometer thermal transmitter from the engine. 13. Disconnect the wiring from the starter. 14, Disconnect the petrol pipe and choke cable and remove the air cleaners from the carburetters. 15. Disconnect the tachometer (if drive type). SYNCHROMESH GEARBOX AND OVERDRIVE 16. Remove the gear lever surround, raise the rubber boot, unscrew and remove the lever retaining bolts. Remove the gear lever. 17. Disconnect the wiring from the reverse light and overdrive isolation switches. 18. Detach the clutch slave cylinder from the gearbox casing and move it clear of the assembly. AUTOMATIC GEARBOX 19. Disconnect the downshift cable from the carburetters. 20. Disconnect the manual control lever from the gearbox shaft. 21. Disconnect the wiring from the inhibitor and reverse light switch. ALL MODELS 22, Disconnect the speedometer cable from the gearbox. 23. Take the weight of the engine on a crane and support the gearbox. 24. Disconnect the exhaust pipe from the manifold and release the pipe clip from the gearbox. 25. Disconnect and remove the propeller shaft—Section G2. 26. Remove the bolts securing the engine front mountings to the frame, EARLY CARS 27. Remove the bolts securing the rear cross-member to the chassis frame and allow the gearbox to rest on the fixed cross-member. 28. Remove the stay rod from the gearbox, A26 = 29. Unscrew the bolts securing the rear mountings to the gearbox and remove the cross-member complete with stay-rod. LATER CARS 30. Remove the four bolts securing the cross-member to the chassis frame. 31. Remove the two bolts securing the bottom tie bracket to the cross-member. 32. Lower the gearbox so that it rests on the fixed cross-member, remove the rear mounting securing nuts, and remove the cross-member. ALL MODELS. 33, Ease the assembly forward until the gearbox is clear of the cross-member, tilt the assembly and lift from the car. 34. Remove the gearbox from the engine as described in Section F.1, Section Fb.1, or Section Fd.10. Refitting the engine 35. Reverse the removing procedure, refill the engine and gearbox with a recommended lubricant, and refill the cooling system with coolant. Section A.22 ENGINE CONTROLS The engine controls comprise the accelerator pedal and the choke control. The accelerator pedal assembly pivots about a bush and distance piece that is supported by a bracket at the top of the pedal box. An accelerator pedal stop is bolted on the front of the pedal box and a pedal return stop on the pedal lever abuts a return stop screw in the top of the pedal box. The upper end of the lever is slotted to accommodate a nipple on the inner end of the accelerator inner cable. The cable passes through a guide bolted to the bulkhead, through an outer cable, and then through a guide on the top of the heat shield. The outer end of the cable. is clamped to a pin attached to the spindle and lever assembly that operates the throttles. The outer cable ends abut the bulkhead guide and the heat shield guide. One end of an accelerator return spring is attached to the spindle and lever assembly and the other end to a clip at the bottom of the heat shield, The choke control is mounted on the fascia adjacent to the ignition/starter switch and comprises a knob, inner cable, and outer cable assembly. The cables pass through a rubber ‘grommet in the bulkhead. The end of the inner cable is clamped to a choke control bracket secured to the front carburetter flange by the air cleaner securing bolts, The outer cable terminates in an abutment that is pinned to the carburetter choke operating lever, When the control is operated the inner cable length is reduced between the bulkhead guide and clamp pin. The outer cable therefore moves along the inner cable and ‘operates the choke lever. MGB. Issue S. 15676 THE ENGINE, A ‘The upper ends of the choke return springs are fitted to the cam levers of the forward and rear carburetters and the lower ends to clips on the bottom of the heat shield. To remove the accelerator control take off the air cleaners as detailed in Section D, release the inner cable from the spindle and lever assembly and withdraw the inner cable from the outer cable at the pedal end, Release the accelerator cable clip in the engine compartment and remove the outer cable. Unscrew the pedal assembly fulcrum bolt from the pedal bracket and remove the petal, bush, and distance piece. Replacement is a reversal of the removal sequence. After replacement ensure that the control is adjusted correctly as detailed in Section D. To remove the choke control release the inner cable from the pin on the choke control bracket and retain the cable abutment. Free the grommet from the bulkhead, From the rear of the fascia panel unscrew the securing nut and withdraw the assembly from the fascia, Replacement is a reversal of the removal sequence, After replacing the accelerator and choke controls ensure that they are correctly adjusted as detailed in Section D. Section A.23 EXHAUST SYSTEM The exhaust system is made up of a front pipe and junction assembly, a front intermediate pipe, a front silencer, a rear intermediate pipe, and a rear silencer and tail pipe. The assembly is welded together. The front pipe and junction assembly mate with the exhaust manifold ports; joint washers are fitted to each pipe. The front intermediate pipe is supported by a clip which is attached to a strap and bracket. The bracket is bolted to the lower flange of the gearbox. A rubber mounting bolted to the rear frame member supports a bushed housing to which is attached the front silencer mounting bracket. A second rubber mounting bolted to the rear frame embodies a split clamp that secures the tail pipe. To remove the exhaust assembly remove the six nuts from the manifold port studs, allow the twin pipes to drop, and retain the joint washers. Loosen the rear mounting tail pipe securing bolt, remove ‘the front silencer support clip bolt, and draw the assembly forward and downward. To refit the assembly reverse the removal sequence but leave the front silencer and tail pipe securing bolts slack until the twin down pipes and joint washers have been fitted and tightened. Tighten the silencer clip bolt and finally the split clamp bolt on the tail pipe. MGB. Issue 9. 80619 Fig. A.28 (Qnd-type) Closed-circuit breathing arrangement. (Inset) Oil filter cap ‘with combined air filter and the breather control valve 1. Spring clip. 4. Metering lever 2. Cover. S. Spring, 3. Diaphragm. 6. Crueiform guides Section A.24 CLOSED-CIRCUIT BREATHING SYSTEM Oil filler cap ‘An air filter is incorporated in the oil filler cap and the two are renewed as an assembly, on engines other than types 18GH, 18GJ or 18GK. Breather control valve (I8GA, 18GB and 18GD engines only) TESTING Run the engine at idling speed at normal running temperature. Remove the oil filler cap and if the valve is functioning correctly the engine speed will be heard to rise by approximately 200 r.p.m. If no change in engine speed occurs the valve must be serviced or renewed. SERVICING Remove the spring clip and dismantle the valve. Clean all metal parts with a solvent (trichlorethylene, fuel, .). Do not use an abrasive. If deposits are difficult to remove, immerse the parts in boiling water before applying the solvent. Clean the diaphragm with detergent or methylated spirits. Replace components showing signs of wear or damage. Reassemble the valve, making sure the metering needle is in the cruciform guides and the diaphragm is seated correctly. NOTE —The Ist-type valve assembly (without the cruciform guides) is serviced as an assembly. A27 THE ENGINE mM Fig. A.29 ‘The distributor drive with the slot in the correct position and the large offset uppermost Section A.25 DISTRIBUTOR DRIVING SPINDLE (18G/18GA) Removing Remove the distributor as detailed in Section B. ‘Take out the screw securing the distributor housing to the cylinder block and withdraw the housing, Screw a a in. UNF. bolt approximately 3% in, (89 mm.) long into the threaded end of the distributor drive spindle and withdraw the spindle, Refitting Turn the crankshaft until No. 1 piston is at T.D.C. on its compression stroke. When the valves on No. 4 cylinder are ‘rocking’ (i.e, exhaust just closing and inlet just opening) No. 1 piston is at the top of its compression stroke. If the ‘engine is set so that the groove in the crankshaft pulley is in line with the largest pointer on the timing chain cover, or the dimples in the crankshaft and camshaft gears are in line, the piston is exactly at T.D.C. Screw the 7 in, by 3% in. UNF. bolt into the threaded end of the distributor drive gear and, holding the drive gear with the slot just below the horizorital and the large offset uppermost, enter the gear. As the gear engages with the camshaft the slot will turn in an anti-clockwise direction until itis approximately in the two o'clock position, Remove the bolt from the gear, insert the distributor housing, and secure it with the special bolt and washer. Ensure that the correct bolt is used and that the head does not protrude above the face of the housing. Refit the distributor, referring to Section B.S if the clamp plate has been released. A28 Section A.26 DISTRIBUTOR DRIVING SPINDLE (18GB) Removing Remove the distributor as detailed in Section B. Take out the screw securing the distributor housing to the evlinder block and withdraw the housing. Screw a % in. UNF. bolt approximately 3% in, (89 mm.) long into the threaded end of the distributor drive spindle and with the crankshaft at 90? or A.T.D.C. (pistons halfway up the bores) withdraw the spindle. Refitting Screw the gin. UNF. bolt into the threaded end of the distributor drive spindle and with the crankshaft in the 90° B, or A.T.D.C. position, enter the spindle. ‘Tur the crankshaft until No. 1 piston is at T-D.C. on its compression stroke. When the valves on No. 4 cylinder are ‘rocking’ (i.e. exhaust just closing and inlet just opening) No. 1 piston is at the top of its compression stroke. If the Fig. A.30 Piston and connecting rod 1. Piston. 9. Connecting rod. 2. Piston ting —scraper. 10. Cylinder wall lubricating jt. 3. Piston rings- taper. LL. Connecting rod cap. 4. Piston ring parallel. 12. Lock washer. S. Smallend bush. 13. Bolts. 6. Gudgeon pin. 14. Connecting rod bearings. 7. Cirelip. 15. Connecting rod and cap 8, Gudgeon pin tubricating marking. hole. MGB. Issue 9, 80619 THE ENGINE A engine is set so that the groove in the crankshaft pulley is in line with the largest pointer on the timing chain cover, or the dimples in the crankshaft and camshaft gears are in line, the piston is exactly at T.D C Withdraw the spindle to clear the camshaft gear and holding the drive gear with the slot just below the horizontal and the large offset uppermost, re-enter the gear. As the gear engages with the camshaft the slot will turn in an anti-clockwise direction until it is approximately in the two clock position. Remove the bolt from the gear, insert the distributor housing, and secure it with the special bolt and washer. Ensure that the correct bolt is used and that the head does not protrude above the face of the housing. Refit the distributor, referring to Section B if the clamp plate has been released. Section A.27 PISTONS AND CONNECTING RODS (18GB) For removing and refitting pistons, piston rings and connecting rods see Section A.14. Dismantling ‘The gudgeon pins are fully floating; remove the two circlips locating each pin and press the pins out. It is essential that the piston assemblies should be replaced in their own bores and fitted the same way round: they should be marked to facilitate this. Reassembling Assemble the pistons to the connecting rods with the gudgeon pin, which should be a hand push fit at a room temperature of 20°C. (68° F.). Secure each pin in its piston with two circlips, ensuring that they fit well into their grooves. Section A.28 OIL COOLER Removing 1. Disconnect the oil cooler pipes from the oil filter, cylinder block and oil cooler connections. 2. Remove the four oil cooler securing bolts and remove the cooler, 3. Withdraw the pipes from the radiator diaphragm grommets. Refitting 4, Reverse the removing procedure. MGB, Ise 7. 87518 Fig A31 ‘A piston and connecting rod assembly with a press fit ‘gudgeon pin Expander rail must butt Top compression ring. Second compression ring, 4. Connecting rod and cap identification. 5. Multisided nut. Section A 29 PISTONS AND CONNECTING RODS (Pres fit gudgeon pin) Pistons and connecting rod assemblies having a press fit gudgeon pin are fully interchangeable in complete sets with earlier assemblies having a fully floating gudgeon pin. Removing 1, Remove the power unit (Section A.21). 2. Remove the engine sump. 3. Remove the cylinder head assembly (Section A.6). A29 A THE ENGINE i anc 962 Fig, A.32 Removing & gudgeon pin, using Service tool 18G 1150 and adaptor set 18G 1150 D “AY = 0.040 in, (1 mm.) endfloat 1. Lock screw. 3. Removerjteplacer bush ange away from gudgeon pin. pin, 4. Gudgeon pin. 4. Mark the bearing caps and connecting rods for reassembly, marking each assembly with the number of the cylinder from which it is taken. Remove the big-end nuts and withdraw the bearing caps. 5. Withdraw the piston and connecting rod assemblies from the top of the cylinder block and refit the bearing caps. Dismantling 6. Remove the piston rings over the crown of the piston. 7. Hold the hexagon body of 18G 1150 in a vice. 8. Screw the large nut back until it is flush with the end of the centre screw, ensure the screw and large nut are well lubricated, and push the screw in until the nut contacts the thrust race. 9. Fit adaptor 18G 1150 D on to the centre screw with the piston ring cut-away uppermost. 10. Slide the parallel sleeve, groove end first, onto the centre screw. 11. Fit the piston, ‘FRONT’ or A towards the adaptor, onto the centre screw. Fit the remover/replacer bush ‘on the centre screw flange end away from the gudgeon pin, IMPORTANT. The gudgeon pin bore is offset and itis essential that the ‘FRONT’ or MM (marked on the piston crown) of the piston is fitted against the adaptor face 12. Screw the stop nut onto the centre screw and adjust to the correct end-float (‘A’ Fig. A.32). Lock the stop nut securely with the lock screw. 13. Check that the remover/replacer bush and paralle! sleeve are correctly positioned in the bore on both sides of the piston, 5. Front of piston, 2 Stop nut. 6. Piston adaptor. 7. Groove in sleeve away from gudgeon 8. Hexagon body. 9. Large nut 10. Centre serew. 14. Screw the large nut up to the thrust race, 15, Hold the lock screw, and turn the large nut (use 18G 587) until the gudgeon pin is withdrawn from the piston. Reassembling GUDGEON PIN 16. Check the piston and connecting rod for alignment. 17, Remove the large nut of 18G 1150 and pull the centre screw out of the body a few inches. Ensure the nut and screw are well lubricated, and the piston support adaptor is in place. 18. Slide the parallel sleeve groove end last onto the centre screw and up to the shoulder. 19. Lubricate the gudgeon pin and bores of the connecting rod and piston with graphited oil (Acheson's Colloids ‘Oildag’). Fit the connecting rod and piston “FRONT” to the tool, with the connecting rod entered on the sleeve up to the groove. 20. Fit the gudgeon pin into the piston bore up to the connecting rod. Fit the remover/replacer bush flange end towards the gudgeon pin. 21. Screw the stop nut onto the centre screw and adjust to the correct end-float (‘A’ Fig. A.33). Lock the nut securely with the lock screw. 22. Screw the large,nut up to the thrust race, 23. Set the torque wrench 18G $87 to 12 Ib. ft. (1.64 kg. m). This represents the minimum load for an acceptable fit. Using the torque wrench and 18G 587 on the large ‘nut, and holding the lock screw, pull the gudgeon pin in until the flange of the remover/replacer bush is the correct distance from the piston skirt (B" Fig. A.33). MGB. Issue 7. 87518, 24, 25. Fig. A33 anc 96 Fitting a gudgeon pin, using Service tool 18G 1150 and adaptor set 18G 1150 D *A’= 0.040 in. (1 mm) end-float. Remover/replacer bush flange towards sgudgeon pin. Under no circumstances must the flange be allowed to contact the piston. NOTE.-If the torque wrench has not broken throughout the pull, the fit of the gudgeon pin to the connecting rod is not acceptable and necessitates the renewal of components. The large nut and centre screw of the tool must be kept well oiled. Remove the Service tool. Check that the piston pivots freely on the pin, and is free to slide sideways. If stiffness exists, wash the assembly in fuel or paraffin (kerosene), lubricate the gudgeon pin with graphited oil (Acheson's Colloids “Oildag’) and re-check. If stiffness persists dismantle and check for ingrained dirt or damage. PISTON RINGS 26. 21, MGB. Enter the piston rings squarely into the top of the cylinder bore and check the gaps (see “GENERAL DATA’). Check the ring to piston groove clearances. Fit the bottom rail of the oil control ring to the piston and position it below the bottom groove. Fit the oil control expander into the bottom groove and move the bottom oil control ring rail up into the bottom groove. Fit the top oil control rail into the bottom groove. Issue 2. 87518 8 4. Gudgeon pin. .080 in. (2 mm.) from piston 7. Groove in sleeve towards gudgeon pin. 11. Lubricate thrust race and screw thread. Check that the ends of the expander are butting but not overlapping (see Fig. A.31) and set the gaps of the rails and the expander at 90 degrees to each other. 28. Fit the thinner of the two compression rings into the second groove with the face marked “TOP” uppermost. 29. Fit the top compression ring, 30. Position the ring gaps at 90 degrees to each other and away from the thrust side of the piston. Refitting 31. Reverse the removal procedure noting the following points. (a) Lubricate the piston rings with graphited oil and stagger the compression ring gaps at 90° to each other. (b) Compress the piston rings using Service tool 18G SSA. Ensure that each connecting rod and piston is refitted into its original bore, the correct way round. Check that the bigend bearings are correctly located in the connecting rods and caps. Use the special multi-sided locknuts and tighten to the torque figure given in ‘GENERAL DATA’. () A3l Valve seat machining dimensions Exhaust (A) Inlet (B) ©. 1.437 to 1.438 in, K, 1,592 to 1.593 in, 36.50 to 36.53 mm) (40.43 to 40.46 mm, D. 186 to..188 in, D. .186 to 188 in. (4.72 164.77 mm). 4.72 104.77 mm). E. Maximum radius 015 in. _E, Maximum radius .015 in. (38 mm.) (38 mm), F, 1,33 10 1.35 in, L. 15852 t0 1,572in, (3.78 to 34.29 mm). 69.42 to 39.93 mm), G. 1.218 to 1.228 in, M. 1.427 to 1.447 in, (30.94 t0 31:19 mm), (36.25 to 36.75 mm, H. Throat diameter 1.146 to _N, Throat diameter 1.302 to 1.166 in. (29.11 to 1,322 in. (33.07 t0 29.62 mm), 33.58 mm). 1 ase 1. 43°, J. Blend from seating to J. Blend from seating to throat diameter throat diameter. Section A.30 VALVE SEAT INSERTS Valve seats that cannot be restored to their original standard by normal cutting and refacing should have valve seat inserts fitted. To fit an insert, machine the cylinder head to the dimensions given (see Fig. A.34). Press in the insert, which will be an interference fit of .0025 to .0045 in. (.06 to .11 mm.). Grind or machine the seats to the dimensions given. Normal valve ‘grinding.in’ may also be necessary to ensure efficient valve seating. = Fig A35 ‘The timing indicator above the pulley. The groove is at 1S°B.T.D.C. for pistons No. | and 4 Fig 436 ‘The relationship of the timing groove to the crankshaft pulley keyway 1. Position when indicator is above pulley. 2 Position when indicator is below pulley Section A.31 IGNITION TIMING INDICATOR The ignition timing indicator is positioned above the crankshaft pulley on later engines (see Fig. A.35). When changing a crankshaft pulley or front cover ensure that the timing groove on the new pulley is correct for the timing indicator position. To modify a pulley, make a saw cut relative to the keyway and obliterate the old groove (see Fig. A.36). ancose Fig 437 Rocker shaft assembly showing shims below the two centre ‘brackets, MGB. Issue 2. 87518 THE ENGINE A Section A.32 ROCKER ASSEMBLY 7 (Later engines) Remove and refit the rocker assembly as detailed in Section A.S, noting the following: (a) Fit a 0.005 in.(0.13 mm) shim under the two centre brackets. These shims should be fitted to early engines on reassembly. (b) Later engines, identified by single valve springs, have bucket-type tappets, longer push-rods and a longer thread on the rocker adjusting screws which are interchangeable as a set with the first-ty pe assembly. Section A.33 VALVEGEAR > (Single Valve Spring) Removing 1. Remove the cylinder head~see Section A.6. 2. Compress the valve spring, using 18G 45, and remove the valve cotter. 3. Release the spring compressor and remove the valve collar, valve spring and valve spring cup. 4, Remove the packing ring and withdraw the valve from its guide. 5, Remove each valve assembly in turn and retain in their installed order. 1. Exhaust valve 3. Valve spring collar. 2 Inlet valve. & Packing ring. 3. Valve spring cup. T. Valve cotter. 4. Valve spring. 8. Compress vaive spring using tool 186 48. MGB. Isuel. 87518 Refitting 6. Insert each valve into its guide in turn and fit the valve spring cup, valve spring and valve collar. Compress the spring, Dip a new packing ring in oil and fit it over the valve stem to just below the cotter groove. Refit the valve cotter and release the spring compressor. Refer to Section A.7 for: Removing and replacing valve guides Grinding and testing valves and seatings Checking valve timing Adjusting valve rocker clearances Section A.34 FRONT COVER AND OIL SEAL (Later Engines) Removing Drain the cooling system and remove the radiator Section C. Slacken the alternator mounting bolts and remove the drive belt. 3. Remove the cooling fan and pulley. 4. Release the locking washer and remove the crankshaft pulley retaining bolt—use tool 18G 98 A. 5. Pull the pulley from the crankshaft. 6. Remove the front cover and gasket; note the screw sizes. 7. Extract the oil seal from the front cover. Refitting 8. Dip the new oil seal in engine oil and fit the seal into the cover, ensuring that the lips of the seal face inwards, using tool 18G 134 and 18G 134 BD. 9 Clean the front cover and front plate joint faces. Ensure the oil thrower is in position with the ‘F marking showing, 10, Smear the locating faces of tool 18G 1046 with oil and fit it into the oil sca. 11. Fit a new joint washer and position the front cover assembly on the crankshaft. Insert all the screws, ensure the seal is centralized and tighten up evenly. Remove tool 18G 1046. 12. Lubricate the hub of the crankshaft pulley, slide the pulley onto the shaft engaging the keyway. 13. Fit a new locking washer. Tighten and lock the retaining bolt. 14. Reverse the procedure in I to 3, A33 A THE ENGINE meer Fig. A.39 Front cover and oil seal 1. Alternator. 6. Crankshaft pulley nut and 2. Daive belt_fan. tool 18G 98 A. 3. Pan and pulley. 7. Front cover and gasket. 4. Crankshaft nut and lock 8. Oil seal washer, 9. Use tool 18G 134 BD to fit 5. Crankshaft pulley. coll seal, Fig. A.40 Centralize the oil seal on the crankshaft using tool 18G 1046 before tightening the front cover screws A34 Section A.35 TIMING CHAIN AND TENSIONER |. — © (Single roller) me Removing 1, Remove the front cover, see Section A.34. 2. Unlock and remove the tensioner securing screws. 3. Prise the tensioner assembly out of its register in the front plate, taking care to retain the slipper head which is under spring tension, and remove the tensioner and its backplate. Remove the backplate and gasket. 4. Allow the spring tension against the slipper head to relax and withdraw the slipper head, spring and inner cylinder from the tensioner body. 5. Unlock and remove the camshaft nut, using tool 18G 98 A. Note that the lock washer tag fits into the groove of the camshaft wheel. 6. Withdraw the crankshaft and camshaft gears; use suitable levers and ease each gear forward a fraction at a time, Note the packing washers positioned behind the crankshaft gear. Fig Ad ‘Timing chain and gears 1. Oil thrower—"F” marking. 8. Chain tensioner assembly 2 Crankshalt gear. and gasket 3. Camshaft nut. 9. Camshaft nut and tool “ 18G 98 A. = 10. Check whee! alignment with a straightedge. i 11. Packing washers crankshaft gear, MGB. Issue 1. 87518 THE ENGINE anc 956 Fig, Aad Crankshaft keyway at T.D.C. and the timing marks ‘opposite fo each other Refitting 7. Crankshaft gear packing washers: Unless new crankshaft or camshaft components have been fitted use the same number of packing washers as original assembly. () Fit the crankshaft and camshaft gears hard against the shaft registers. (@ Check the alignment of the gear teeth using a straight-edge, Measure the gap with a feeler gauge and subtract 0.005 in, (0.13 mm.) Remove the drive keys from the crankshaft and fit packing washers to the thickness calculated in (id. Packing washers are supplied in a thickness of 0.006 in. (0.15 mm.). Refit the drive keys. Gi) 8. Rotate the crankshaft so that its keyways are at T.D.C. and camshaft with its keyway at two o’clock position. 9. Assemble the timing chain and gear wheels with the timing marks opposite each other, engage the crankshaft key and rotate the camshaft as necessary to engage the camshaft gear keyway. 10. Fit a new lock washer, tighten the nut and lock the camshaft nut MGB. Ise 1. 87518 WL 13. Refit the chain tensioner: (i Refit the inner cylinder and spring into the bore of the slipper head so that the serrated helical slot engages with the peg in the bore. Turn the inner cylinder clockwise against spring tension until the lower serration in the slot engages with the peg and retains the inner cylinder. Refit the slipper assembly into the tensioner body. Insert a 0.06 in. (1.6 mm.) spacer between the slipper head and body to prevent disengagement. ‘Assemble the tensioner and its backplate to the engine. Remove the spacer, press the slipper head into the body and release it to disengage the inner cylinder. Position the oil thrower on the crankshaft with the ‘F” marking showing. Refit the front cover, see Section A.34. Gi (ii) (iv) (vy) 3ncs70 Fig, A43 ‘Timing chain tensioner assembly Gasket. S. Inner cylinder. Backplate, 6 Spring Spacer to prevent disengagement. 7. Tensioner body. 8. Slipper head. A35 Section Aa ‘The information given in this Section refers specifically to service operations on, or affected by, equipment fitted to the MGB (GHNS and GHDS) in conformity with local and territorial requirements, and must be used in conjunction with Section A. SECTION Enginerestraint, Aad MGB. Issue 1. 86842 Aal THE ENGINE ancoss Fig Aa The engine restraint Engine restraint tube. Front nut 1 2 3. Rear nut 4, Rear plate s. Rear buffer, Section Aa.1 ENGINE RESTRAINT (GHNS and GHDS Cars from Car No. 341295) Removing 1. Slacken the restraint tube front nut. 2. Remove the restraint tube rear nut and withdraw the rear plate and buffer. 3. Remove the nut and bolt securing the restraint tube to the gearbox bracket and withdraw the restraint tube Aa2 Gearbox bracket, Distance tube. Front butter. Front plate, Engine mounting rar cros-member bracket from the bracket on the rear engine mounting ccross-member. 4. Remove the distance tube, front buffer and plate from the restraint tube. Refitting 5. Reverse the procedure in 1 to 4, noting the following: a. Inspect the buffer for damage and deterioration, and renew if necessary. b, Tighten the restraint tube rear nut first, then tighten the front nut. MGB. Issue 1. 86842 MGB. SECTION B THE IGNITION SYSTEM + Distributor—Lucas type 2SD4. Assembling + Dismantling Examining .. Removing and replacing #Servicing Distributor—Lucas type 45D4 ‘}Dismantling and reassembling .. HInspection . ++Removing and refitting #Servicing High-tension cables Ignition coil Locating the cause of uneven firing . Low-tension circuit Locating a fault Testing Lubrication Sparking plugs +Static ignition timing + These operations must be followed by an exhaust emission check. | 2: Issue 5. 89961 SECTION B3 B3 BO BT BS BA B16 B16 B16 B.S B.10 B2 B.i2 B14 B13 BA Bul Bg Bu B THE IGNITION SYSTEM Section B.1 LUBRICATION Distributor CAM BEARING Lift the rotor off the top of the spindle by pulling it squarely, and add a few drops of thin oil to the cam bearing. Do not remove the cam securing screw which is exposed: there is a clearance between the screw and the inner face of the spindle for the oil to pass. Replace the rotor with its drive lug correctly engaging the spindle slot and push it onto the shaft as far as it will go. CAM Lightly smear the cam with a very small amount of grease or, if this is not available, clean engine oil may be used. AUTOMATIC TIMING CONTROL ‘Add a few drops of thin oil through the hole in the contact breaker base through which the cam passes. Do not allow oil to get on or near the contacts. Do not over-oil. Section B.2 IGNITION COIL Removing Disconnect the switch, contact breaker and H.T. cables, release the coil securing bolts and remove the coil, Testing ‘An indication of the state of serviceability of the coil may be obtained by assessing the quality of spark produced by the coil under test conditions. The test circuit and equipment are illustrated in Fig, B.1. ! E 3 Fig. Bl ‘Test circuit and gap measurement 1, Auxiliary electrode, 3. SW. contact. 2. HT. contact. 4. CB contact. 5. Distributor B2 The primary circuit make and break is obtained by using a six-lobe contact breaker cam and graduated scale and adjusting the contact breaker gap until a closed period of between 18 and 20°is obtained. The gap must be accurately set by using feeler gauges on each lobe of the cam in turn. ‘The contact breaker lever spring tension must be between 18 and 20 oz. (510 and 566 gm.) measured at the contacts and the condenser capacity .18 to .25 mf. The three-point test gap equipment is to be connected so that the auxiliary electrode is on the H.T. side of the circuit. This electrode causes the gap to break down at low voltage, a condition used during the setting of the gap for the high-speed performance test. The coil must be mounted at an angle of 45° on the test rig with the C.B, terminal uppermost and the coil case earthed. ‘The mounting angle ensures that the primary winding take-off to the L.T. terminal is not covered with fluid and any internal tracking between the iron core and the primary lead will be shown up during test. Earthing the coil case detects whether or not short circuits to earth are present. High-speed performance test Connect a peak voltmeter across the spark gap, run the distributor at any speed and then produce irregular sparking by tapping down the battery or by inserting a resistance in the primary circuit. Adjust the gap until the peak reading on the voltmeter is 8 KV. Remove the voltmeter, and revert to 12 volts or remove the resistance from the circuit. Run the distributor at 3,750 r.p.m. and check the spark. No missing should occur at this speed. Low-speed performance test Set the spark gap to .44 in, (11 mm) and retain the auxiliary electrode in the circuit. The coil should be at 20° C.68°F.). Run the distributor at 100 p.m. and note the number of misses. These should not exceed 30 per minute. Resistance test Remove the coil and connect a Megger across the C.B. and HT. contacts and note the reading and then across the S.W. and H.T. contacts and note the reading. The readings must be within the limits given in the “GENERAL DATA’. Section B.3 DISTRIBUTOR The Type 25D distributor incorporates a one-piece body-shank casting which houses the distributor drive shaft, automatic advance mechanism, contact breaker plate MGB. Issue S. 89961 THE IGNITION SYSTEM B assembly, capacitor, cam, rotor arm and their associated electrical connections. The direction of rotation is stamped on the body. The upper end of the body is closed by a bakelite cap which houses the plug lead segments and the H.T. lead brush and spring. The automatic advance mechanism comprises a centrifugally operated rolling weight mechanism and a vacuum-operated mechanism which together advance the ignition point in proportion to the engine speed and load. The vacuum-operated mechanism has a vernier adjustment screw to enable small adjustments to be made to suit varying grades of fuel or to satisfy tuning requirements. A double-headed arrow marked ‘A’ and ‘R’ is stamped on the body adjacent to the vernier screw. A fuel trap is incorporated in the vacuum line from the induction manifold, The contact breaker assembly is made up of a base plate secured to the distributor body, a moving contact breaker plate, a fixed contact breaker plate, the contact breaker points, and a capacitor. The moving plate is supported on the base plate by two nylon pads, which minimizes friction when the automatic advance moves the plate. A °C’ spring anchored to a vacuum control spring post bears against the under side of the base plate and so pre-tilts the moving plate. The pressure of the cam on the heel of the contact breaker points supplements this action and so minimizes rocking of the moving plate at high cam speeds. A stud fixed to the under side of the moving contact plate engages a slot in the base plate and so limits the horizontal movement of the moving plate; the stud also limits the angle of tilt of the moving plate The fixed contact breaker plate is secured by a screw which passes through a slot in the fixed plate. A notch cut in the free end of the plate permits the engagement of a screwdriver for adjustment purposes when setting the contact breaker points gap. The distributor is secured to the engine by a split housing plate and clamp bolt. On some distributors the clamp bolt is trapped and the nut free and on others the nut is trapped and the bolt is free. . Section B.4 SERVICING THE DISTRIBUTOR Contact breaker points Examine the contact breaker points and if they are found to be bumt or blackened remove them as described in Section B.6 and clean them with a fine carborundum stone or emery-cloth. After cleaning, remove all traces of dust and grease with a petrol-moistened cloth. Lightly smear the contact breaker pivot pin with molybdenized non-creep oil or a suitable grease and refit the points. It is important that no oil or grease is contaminate the contact breaker points. MGB. Issued, 1329 jowed to Reset the gap by rotating the crankshaft until the contacts are at their maximum open position, slacken the fixed plate securing screw, insert a screwdriver between the notches in the fixed plate and adjust the gap until it is between .014 and .016 in, (.36 and .40 mm.), Tighten the securing screw and re-check the gap setting, Distributor cover Thoroughly clean the moulded cover with a petrol-moistened cloth, paying particular attention to the spaces between the electrodes. Examine the cover for cracks and signs of tracking. Inspect the carbon brush for serviceability and ensure that it moves freely in its holder. Check the H.T leads for security and examine them for signs of deterioration. Cracked or perished leads must be renewed. To fit new HT. leads, remove the old leads, fill the holes in the distributor cap with Silicone grease, and cut the new leads off to the requited length. Push the ends of the leads fully home in the cap and secure them with the securing screws. Remove the suppressors from the old leads and fit them to the new ones Vacuum advance To check the vacuum advance, fit a modified cap having a window cut in the side. Start the engine, operate the throttle sharply, and observe the movement of the moving contact breaker plate, Centrifugal advance Remove the distributor cover, grasp the rotor firmly, and turn it in the direction of rotation, Release the rotor, when it should return to its original position without showing any tendency to stick, Capacitor If the capacitor is suspect it may be tested by substitution, Disconnect the suspect capacitor and connect a new one between the L.T terminal and earth. Should a new capacitor be necessary, remove the old one and fit the new as described in Section B. Ass25B8 Fig. B2 ‘The distributor fixed plate securing screw and screwdriver notches B3 B THE IGNITION SYSTEM Section B.S to the segment in the cover for No. 1 cylinder plug lead, This will provide a datum for replacement. REMOVING AND REPLACING THE 2, Remove the distributor cover, L:T. lead, and the DISTRIBUTOR: suction advance pipe union from the distributor. 3. Remove the two screw securing the split housing plate to the distributor housing. Do not remove or disturb the split housing plate clamp bolt. To remove the distributor from the engine disconnect the suction advance pipe union from the distributor, the H.T. leads from the sparking plugs, and the L-T. lead from the distributor. Remove the two screws securing the split ith ca the diserao tor from ts housibe housing plate to the engine and lift the distributor from its ‘5. insert the distributor into its housing until the driving housing, dogs on the distributor drive shaft rest on the distributor driving spindle. Replacement is a reversal of these instructions, after which the ignition timing must be set or re-checked as described in © Slowly rotate the rotor arm until the driving dogs engage the slots in the drive spindle, Both the dogs Section B.9 and the slots are offset to ensure correct replacement. If it is desired to remove and replace the distributor 7, Tyan the distributor body to align the holes in the without disturbing the timing proceed as follows: . housing plate with those in the housing and secure the 1. Rotate the crankshaft until the rotor arm is pointing plate with the two screws. 8. Provided the crankshaft has not been rotated the rotor arm will be opposite the segment for No. 1 plug lead. 9. Refit the cap, plug leads, L-T. lead, and vacuum pipe union. Section B.6 DISMANTLING THE DISTRIBUTOR To dismantle the distributor for overhaul remove it from the engine as described in Section B.S and then proceed as, follows: 1. Remove the distributor cap and from it withdraw the carbon brush and its spring. Remove the rotor arm, 2, Lift the LT. connector housing from the body, unscrew the two screws securing the contact breaker plates assembly, and disconnect the vacuum advance spring from its anchorage. Lift off the contact breaker plates assembly. Unscrew the contact breaker spring anchorage mut and remove the nut, collar, L-T. lead and capacitor lead tags, moving contact breaker point, and the fibre washer. 4. Unscrew the fixed contact breaker plate securing screw and lift off the plate. 5, Remove the capacitor securing screw and the Fie. capacitor. ‘The distibutor components 6. Rotate the reriioving plate and disengage the stud on it 1. Clamping pate 11. cam from the base plate. Disengage the base plate from the 2. Moulded cap. 12, Automatic advance springs. ‘C’ spring on the moving plate. & Rowan Te Sheftand action pe 7. Remove the cam securing screw, the rolling weight 5) Contacts (st) 15. Cap retaining clips springs, cam and action plate, and the weights. tee Aso aneee 8. Check the driving shaft end-float and clearance in the (ow-tension) 18 Thrust washer, body bush. belle in eam Ss br 9. Drive out the driving dog securing pin and remove the 9, Contact breaker base plate. 21. Cam screw. driving dog and thrust washer from the drive shaft. 10. Earth ead. 22. ‘O" ing ol seal Withdraw the drive shaft from the body. MGB. Issue 4. 1329 THE IGNITION SYSTEM B 10. Remove the micro adjuster spring clip, unscrew the nut, and remove the spring and vacuum control from the body. Section B.7 EXAMINING THE DISTRIBUTOR In addition to carrying out the examination detailed in Section B.5 examine all parts for wear, deterioration, and thread damage, and the driving dog and rolling weights for indentation. Examine the °O" ring oil seal (if fitted) on the shank for deterioration. \sorn or unserviceable parts should be renewed. If the clearance between the action plate shaft and the body bush is excessive the bush may be renewed as follows 1. Souk the new bush in S.A.E. 30 or 40 oil for 24 hours. Alternatively, place the bush in oil and heat to 100°C. (21% F) for 2 hours. Allow the oil to cool and remove bush. 2. Using a shouldered mandrel, press the old bush out from the inside of the body. 3. Insert the new bush into the shank end of the body smallest diameter of the bush leading. The bush will be a push fit until the large diameter contacts the body. 4, Use a mandrel, vice, press, or bush drawing tool to press the bush fully home with an applied steady pressure. 5. When pressed fully home the bush should be flush with the end of the body shank and should protrude ightly inside the body. 6. Using the shank drain hole as a guide, drill through the bush and then remove all fragments of metal 7. Lubricate the action shaft with clean engine oil, ensure that no fraze exists around the hole in the shaft through which the driving dog pin passes, and then insert the shaft into the body shank. 8. If the shaft is a tight fit in the body repeat operation (7) until the shaft is free to rotate without binding. This is most important. 9. Run the shaft in the body with a lathe or test rig for 15 minutes, re-lubricate the shaft, and assemble the distributor. 10. Under no circumstances must the bush be over-bored since this will impair the porosity and thereby the effective lubricating qualities of the bush. Section B.8 ASSEMBLING THE DISTRIBUTOR Assembly is a reversal of the dismantling sequence, but attention must be given to the following points during assembly’ 1, Lubricate the components. 2. Set the micro-adjuster to the mid-way position. MGB. Issue 8. 80619 Fig. BA The notch in the pulley approaching the T.D.C. position for pistons 1 and 4. The inset shows the timing scale S* marks 3. Adjust the contact breaker points to the correct gap. 4, Leave the clamp plate securing bolt slack. 5. After fitting the distributor to its housing rotate the rotor arm until the driving dog engages the recess in the distributor drive from the camshaft. The lugs on the dog are offset to ensure correct replacement. Section B.9 STATIC IGNITION TIMING To set the ignition timing proceed as follows: 1. Check the contact breaker gap setting 2. Rotate the crankshaft until the valves of No. 4 cylinder are ‘rocking’ (ie. exhaust valve just closing and inlet valve just opening). In this position No. 1 cylinder is approximately at T.D.C. compression stroke. 3. Refer to the ‘GENERAL DATA’ for the correct ignition setting and rotate the crankshaft until the notch on the crankshaft pulley is opposite the correct, pointer on the timing cover case for the required setting. The long pointer indicates T.D.C. 4. Rotate the distributor body anti-clockwise until the points are fully closed, then slowly rotate it in a clockwise direction until the points just commence to open. Alternatively, connect a 12-volt lamp in parallel with the contact breaker points (i.e. one lead to the L.T. terminal and the other to earth), switch on the ignition and turn the distributor as above until the amp lights. This indicates that the points have just opened, 5. Slacken the clamp plate set bolts and secure the B THE IGNITION SYSTEM assasw Fig. BS The vernier adjustment nut clamp plate nut or bolt. The correct torque tightening figures are given in the ‘GENERAL DATA’. Tighten the clamp plate set bolts. 6. If the static ignition timing figures is between T.D.C. and S° B.T.D.C., or between 5° B.T.DC. and 10° B.T.DC., adjust the vacuum control adjusting screw to obtain the correct setting. Approximately 55 clicks of the screw will move the vacuum control barrel one graduation on the scale, and each graduation is equal to approximately 5° of movement on the moving plate. 7. Check that the rotor is opposite the correct electrode in the distributor cap for No. | cylinder. Should a stroboscopic lamp be used for timing the ignition, care must be taken that with the engine running the speed is low enough to ensure that the centrifugal advance weights are not in operation. If the vacuum advance take-off is direct from the induction manifold the oezsiew Fig. B.6 The correct method of fitting @ high-tension cable to the ignition coil terminal nut BS take-off must be disconnected before attempting the timing, otherwise the timing will be retarded. Section B.10 HIGH-TENSION CABLES ‘The high-tension cables must be examined carefully and any which have the insulation cracked, perished, or damaged in any way must be renewed. To fit the cables to the terminal of the ignition coil thread the knurled moulded terminal nut over the lead, bare the end of the cable for about % in, (6 mm.), thread the wire through the brass washer removed from the original cable, and bend back the strands over the washer. Finally, screw the terminal into the coil To make the connections to the terminals in the distributor moulded cap first remove the cap and slacken the screws on the inside of the moulding till they are clear of the cables. Fig. BT ‘The correct method of connecting high-tension leads 1, Carbon brush 2. Cable securing sezew. Remove the cables. Fill the holes in the distributor cap with Silicone grease, then cut the new cables off to the required length, push them completely home, and tighten the securing screws. ‘The cables from the distributor to the sparking plugs must be connected up in the correct firing order, which is 1, 3. 4. 2. Secure them firmly to the connectors. Radio-frequency-suppressed high-tension cables are used on later cars. In this cable, a graphite-impregnated core replaces the metallic conductor of the earlier type of cable. Connectors used with the metal-cored cable are unsuitable for use with the later cable and new-type cable connectors hhave been introduced; these are a push-ft to the coil and distributor covers. MGB. Ise 8. 80619 THE IGNITION SYSTEM B ae 6 so1078W Fig. BS ‘The comect astembly method for later-type suppressed high tension cables Coil ead ‘ug teads 1. Fish-hook connector. 4, Insulation removed for % in. 2.7mm), 2. Flush cable end. 5, Inner cord folded onto cable, staple pushed into the centre of the cord as far as possible. 3. Assembly of fish-hook and 6. Cord and staple must make lead cover. a good contact with body of connector, Section B.11 ‘SPARKING PLUGS Inspect, clean, adjust and renew sparking plugs at the recommended mileage intervals. Before replacing the plug in the engine, test it for correct functioning under air pressure in a plug tester, following out the instructions issued by the makers of the plug tester. Generally speaking, a plug may be considered satisfactory for further service if it sparks continuously under a pressure of 100 Ib. per sq. in. (7 kg/cm) with the gap between the points set at .022 in. (.56 mm.). It is essential that the plug points should be reset to the correct gap (see ‘GENERAL DATA’) before the plug is refitted to the engine. When replacing a plug, always screw it down by hand as far as possible and use the spanner for final tightening only. Whenever possible use a box spanner to avoid possible fracture of the insulator, Where a torque spanner is available 14mm, plugs should be tightened to between 27 and 30 Ib, ft. (3.7 and 4.1 kg. m.). Section B.12 LOCATING THE CAUSE OF UNEVEN FIRING Start the engine and set it to run at a fairly fast idling speed. MGB. Issue 4, 89961 Short-circuit each plug in turn by placing a hammer head or the blade of a screwdriver with a wooden or insulated handle between the terminal and the cylinder head. No difference in the engine performance will be noted when short-circuiting the plug in the defective cylinder. Shorting the other plugs will make running more pronounced. Having located the cylinder which is at fault, stop the engine and remove the cable from the terminal of the sparking plug. Restart the engine and hold the end of the cable about #in. (4.8 mm.) from the cylinder head. If the sparking is strong and regular, the fault probably lies in the sparking plug. Remove the plug, clean, and adjust the gap to the correct setting, or alternatively, fit a new plug (see Section B.11). If there is no spark or if it is weak and irregular, examine the cable from the sparking plug to the distributor. After a long period of service, the insulation may be cracked or perished, in which case the cable should be renewed, Finally, examine the distributor moulded cap, wipe the inside and outside with a clean dry cloth, see that the carbon brush moves freely in its holder and examine the moulding closely for signs of breakdown. After long service it may become tracked, that is, a conducting path may have formed between two or more of the electrodes or between one of the electrodes and some part of the distributor in contact with the cap. Evidence of a tracked cap is shown by the presence of a thin black line in the places indicated. A replacement distributor cap must be fitted in place of one that has become tracked. Section B.13 ‘TESTING THE LOW-TENSION CIRCUIT Spring back the securing clips on the distributor and remove the moulded cap and rotor. If the rotor is a tight fit, it can be levered off carefully with a screwdriver. Check that the contacts are clean and free from pits, burns, oil, or grease. Turn the engine and check that the contacts are opening and closing correctly and that the clearance is correct when the contacts are fully opened to between .014 and .016 in, (.36 and .40 mm.). Correct the gap if necessary. Disconnect the cable at the contact breaker terminal of the coil and at the low-tension terminal of the distributor, and connect a test lamp between these terminals. If the lamp lights when the contacts close and goes out when the contacts open, the low-tension circuit is in order. Should the lamp fail to light, the contacts are dirty or there is a broken or loose connection in the low-tension wiring. BI B THE IGNITION SYSTEM Section B.14 LOCATING A LOW-TENSION CIRCUIT FAULT Having determined, by testing as previously described, that the fault lies in the low-tension circuit, switch on the ignition, and turn the engine until the contact breaker points are fully opened. Refer to the wiring diagram and check the circu voltmeter (0-20 volts) as follows. NOTE.-If the circuit is in order, the reading on the voltmeter should be approximately 12 volts. 1. Battery to control box terminal “B’. Connect a voltmeter between control box terminal “B’ and earth. No reading indicates a damaged cable or loose connections. 2. Control box terminal ‘B’ to ignition switch terminal (brown lead). Connect a voltmeter between the ignition terminal and earth, No reading indicates a damaged cable or loose connections, 3. Ignition switch (white lead). Connect a voltmeter between the the ignition switch terminal and earth. Turn the ignition key to the ignition position. No reading indicates a fault in the ignition switch. 4. Ignition switch (white with red lead). Connect a voltmeter between the ignition switch terminal and earth. Turn the ignition key to the start position. No reading indicates a fault in the ignition swite 5. Ignition switch to fusebox terminal “A3” (white lead). Connect a voltmeter between the fuse unit terminal “A” and earth, No reading indicates a damaged cable or loose connections. Fusebox terminal “A3" to ignition coil terminal ‘SW’. Connect a voltmeter to the ignition coil terminal “SW and to earth. No reading indicates a fault in the ary winding of the coil and » new coil must be fitted Section B.15 SERVICING THE DISTRIBUTOR— Lucas type 4504. [>] Lubrication 1. Remove the distributor cover and rotor arm. 2. Lightly smear the cam and pivot post with grease. 3. Add a few drops of oil to the felt pad in the top of the cam spindle. 4. Add a few drops of oil through the gap between the cam spindle and base plate to lubricate the centrifugal weights. 5. Every 25,000 miles lubricate the contact breaker assembly centre bearing with a drop of oil in each of the two holes in the base plate. CAUTION: Do not oil the cam wiping pad. Fig. 8.9 The rotor removed to show the lubrication points~Lucas 45D4. 1. Rotor. 2. Cam and pivot post 3. Felt pad in the cam, 4. Gap between cam and base- plate (to lubricate centeifugal ‘weights). $. Centre beating. Renewing contact breaker points 6. Remove the securing screw with its spring and flat washer. 7. Lift the contact set. 8. Press the spring and release the terminal plate from the end of the spring. 9. Before fitting new contact points, wipe the points clean with fuel or methylated spirit. 10. Lightly grease the pivot post. 11. Reeonnect the terminal plate to the end of the contact breaker spring. 12. Position the contact set on the distributor base plate and lightly tighten the securing screw. Ensure that the contact breaker spring is firmly in its register on the insulator and set the contact breaker gap. Fig. B.10 Removing a contact breaker set—Lucas 454. Securing screw. 5. Heel of contact point on Terminal plate and contact highest point of any one of breaker spring. the cam lobes. Pivot post 6, Slotin contact breaker plate Contact breaker points. for adjusting gap with screwdriver, MGB. Issue 4. 89961 THE IGNITION SYSTEM B Contact breaker gap—Checking— Adjusting 13. Turn the crankshaft until the heel of the contact point is on the highest point of any one of the cam lobes. 14, Check the contact gap; it should be 0.014 to 0.016 in. (0.35 to 0.40 mm,). 15. Adjust the gap; to adjust insert a screwdriver in the slot in the contact breaker plate and lever against the pip or cutout provided on the base plate. 16. Tighten the securing screw. 17. Turn the crankshaft until the heel of the contact is on the highest point of and alternative cam lobe. 18. Re-check the contact gap. 19. Repeat 17 and 18 for each remaining cam lobe. Distributor cap—checking 20. Unclip and remove the distributor cap. 21. Remove the rotor arm. 22. Using a clean, nap-free cloth, wipe the rotor arm and the inside of the distributor cap. 23, Examine the cap and arm for cracks and signs of electrical tracking. Renew if necessary. 24. Check the condition and operation of the carbon brush. Refit the distributor cap. Distributor dwell angle 25. Using suitable equipment, check the distributor dwell angle. 26. Readjust the contact breaker gap to obtain the correct siquiesse Surre9g, dund s9iem—auey, (Aaqind 5691 4 en Aiquuasse dung, 8 8 L 9 s ON 7 i C7 Issue 5. 80619 MGB. C THE COOLING SYSTEM of the radiator. On I8GD and 18GG engines the engine cylinder block drain tap is replaced by a removable plug and sealing washer. LATER CARS Later cars have no provision for draining the radiator and the use of antifreeze all-the-year round is recommended. To drain the coolant from the radiator, slacken the radiator bottom hose clip and remove the hose at its connection to the radiator. When the system is completely drained and refilling is to be deferred until some later date a suitable notice should be fixed to the radiator filler cap, indicating that the coolant has been drained. As an alternative, place the radiator filler cap on the driver's seat or leave the filler cap access panel open as a reminder to fill the cooling system before the vehicle is used again NOTE.--If a heater is fitted, under no circumstances should draining of the cooling system be resorted to as an alternative to the use of anti-freeze mixture, due to the fact that complete draining of the heater unit by means of the cooling system drain taps is not possible. To ensure sufficient circulation of the coolant and to reduce the formation of scale and sediment in the radiator the system should be periodically flushed out with clear running water, preferably before putting in anti-freeze solution and again after taking it out The water should be allowed to run through until it comes ‘out clear from the taps. This method is adequate under normal conditions, but in extreme cases where excessive “furring up’ is experienced a more efficient method is to completely remove the radiator and flush in the reverse way to the flow, ie. turn the radiator upside-down and let the water flow in through the bottom hose and out of the top connection. Filling the cooling system Close the radiator and cylinder block drain taps. ‘ssoncw Fig. C2 ‘The location of the radiator drain tap (Early cars) cs Ensure that all hose connections are tight. Fill up the system through the filler in the radiator header tank until the level of water can just be seen, Run the engine until it is hot and then add sufficient water to raise the level to within 1 in, (25.4mm,) of the bottom of the filler neck. When possible, soft water, such as clean rain-water, should be used to fill the system, When using anti-freeze solution avoid overfilling to prevent loss from expansion. Anti-freeze solutions having an alcohol base are unsuitable for use in the cooling system owing to the high temperatures attained in the top radiator tank. Only antifreeze solutions of the ethylene glycol type incorporating the correct type of corrosion inhibitor should bbe employed, (See Section C.8). Section CS FAN BELT To fit a new fan belt slacken slightly the two bolts on which the dynamo pivots and release the bolt securing it to the slotted link and the nut securing the slotted link to the engine. Move the dynamo to the engine as far as possible. Slide the belt over the fan and onto the fan pulley; ease the belt onto the crankshaft pulley and dynamo pulley. It may be found helpful to tur the engine with the starting-handle whilst easing the belt over the dynamo pulley. Adjustment is made by raising the dynamo upwards away from the engine.A gentle hand pull only must be exerted on the dynamo, or the belt tension will be excessive and undue strain will be thrown onto the dynamo bearings. Tighten up the bolts with the dynamo in this position. The belt should be sufficiently tight to prevent slip, yet it should be possible to move the belt laterally 1 in. (2.5 cm.) in the centre of its longest run, On cars fitted with alternators the fan belt is renewed and adjusted in a similar manner. Section C.6 RADIATOR AND DIAPHRAGM The radiator block assembly is supported in a metal diaphragm which is secured to the body sides by screws and washers. The diaphragm has two holes in the right-hand side to permit the oil cooler pipes to pass from the cooler to the engine. A rubber air seal is fitted across the top channel of the diaphragm. ‘The radiator is supported in the diaphragm by three screws and washers each side and a tie-bar running forward from each top screw to the body sides. The overflow pipe is secured by two clips that are retained by a radiator fixing screw and a diaphragm fixing screw respectively. MB. Issue 5. 80619 THE COOLING SYSTEM Removing To remove the radiator drain the coolant~Section C.4, release the top and bottom hose clips, and detach the hoses, from their connectors. Where an oil cooler is not fitted the radiator and diaphragm may be removed as a complete assembly by removing the top radiator to diaphragm screws to release the stays and then removing the screws securing each side of the diaphragm to the body. If an oil cooler is fitted the pipe connections must be disconnected from the cooler and the engine before removing the radiator and diaphragm assembly. To remove the radiator without the diaphragm undo the radiator to diaphragm securing screws, slacken the diaphragm to body securing screws, remove the screw retaining the overflow pipe clip, and then lift the diaphragm sufficiently to allow the radiator to be pulled forward and lifted from the car. Replacing Replacement is a reversal of the removal sequence, but ye y Fig. C4 ‘The dynamo mounting bolts Which must be slackened for fan belt tension adjustment Dismantling S. Withdraw the pulley hub from the spindle. ensure that the two packing pieces are correctly positioned 6. Withdraw the bearing locating wire from the body either side of the radiator and that the overflow pipe is aperture. secured. 7. Tap the spindle rearwards and remove the spindle complete with the bearing, The bearing cannot be Close the drain taps, fill with coolant, and check for leaks. removed from the spindle. 8, Withdraw the impeller from the spindle and remove the seal. Section €.7 Reassembling WATER PUMP 9. If the interference fit of the fan hub was impaired when the hub was withdrawn from the spindle a new Removing nut must be fitted. The hub must be fitted with its 1, Remove the radiator—Seetion C.6. face flush with the end of the spindle (B, Fig. C.3) 2. Remove the dynamo or alternator. 10. Press the spindle bearing assembly into the pump 3. Unscrew the fan and pulley retaining screws and body and take measurement .E, Fig, C.5; adjust the remove the fan and pulley. 4, Remove the water pump securing bolts and withdraw the pump. C. asew Fig. C3 ‘A section through the water pump showing: (let) early type with grease plug, and (right) later sealed type A. Lubricating hole. B. Hub face flush with spindle 28729 MGB. Issue 4. C. .020 t0 030 in. ($1 10.76 mm, clearance. D. 042 to :062 in. (1.1 to 1.6 mm.) clearance. co ( THE COOLING SYSTEM position of the spindle bearing assembly to obtain the correct measurement. (2) On pumps fitted with the early-type seal and thrower, check the bearing to thrower clearance before fitting the spindle (D, Fig. C.3), (b) On pumps fitted with a greaser plug, align the holes in the bearing and body (A, Fig. C.3) 11. Fit a new seal. Smear the jointing face of the seal with a mineral base oil to ensure a watertight joint. 12. Press the impeller onto the spindle, ensuring that the correct running clearance (C, Fig. C.3) is maintained between the impeller vanes and the pump body. Refitting 10. Reverse the removing procedure in 1 to 4, Mosse Fig. cs Pump with later-type seal, thrower deleted E. Distance from rear face of spindle beating (outer track) to seal housing shoulder should be .$34 in.£.005 in, (13.56 mm.t-13 mm.) (pumps fitted with later-type seal onty), Section C& COLD WEATHER PRECAUTIONS ‘As the cooling system is pressurized, relatively high temperatures are developed in the radiator upper tank. For this reason anti-freeze solutions having an alcohol base are unsuitable owing to their high evaporation rate producing rapid loss of coolant and a consequent interruption of the circulation of coolant. Only anti-freeze solution of the ethylene glycol type incorporating the correct type of corrosion inhibitor is suitable for use in the cooling system, and the recommended make is Bluecol, or any anti-freeze solution which conforms to Specification B.S, 3151 or B.S. 3152. The anti-freeze solution should be made up in the proportions given in the table below. Itis advisable for vehicles with an anti-freeze solution in the cooling system to have an identification mark on the header tank of the radiator. ‘The following precautions are necessary on vehicles so marked. Make sure that the strength of the mixture is, in fact up to that instructed on the container of the particular anti-freeze solution used. The strength of the mixture must be maintained by topping up with the anti-freeze solution as necessary when the system is hot. Topping up with water alone will reduce the degree of protection provided. If the cooling system has to be emptied run the contents into clean containers, strain, and use agai. Anti-freeze can remain in the cooling system for two years provided that the specific gravity of the coolant is checked periodically and anti-freeze added as required. Specialized equipment, which can be obtained from the anti-freeze manufacturer, is necessary to check the specific gravity. After the second winter, drain the system and flush out. Refill with fresh water or the recommended anti-freeze solution. If for any reason the coolant is lost and the system is filled with water remove the identification mark from the radiator header tank. Antisfreeze Commences to freeze Frozen solid Amount of antifreeze ] % °c. oR, °C. °F, Prs, US.Pts. Litres 28 -13 9 =26 1s % 3 14 | 334 -19 2 =36 33 3% 4 20 | 50 36 33 48 53 5 | 6 28 MGB. Issue8. 25729 THE COOLING SYSTEM ( Section C.9 DRAINING AND REFILLING THE COOLING SYSTEM (GHNS and GHDS cars from Car No. 410002) Draining 1. Stand the vehicle on level ground. 2. Remove the expansion tank cap and the filler plug from the coolant outlet pipe, 3. Slacken the hose clip and disconnect the bottom hose at the radiator, 4. Remove the cylinder block drain plug Filling 5. Refit the bottom hose and cylinder block drain plug, 6. Check that all hose connections are tight. 7. Tum the heater temperature control knob to “HOT” to, open the heater valve. 8. Top up the coolant in the expansion tank so that the tank is half-full and refit the cap. 9. Fill the system through the filler neck and bring the level up to the bottom of the threads 10, Refit the filler plug, }1, Run the engine until the top radiator hose is warm and switch off the engine 12. Tum the expansion tank cap to its safety stop to release the pressure and if necessary top up the expansion tank to half-full. Refit the cap. 13. Remove the filler plug and top up once more to the bottom of the threads. Refit the filler plug. Section C.10 WATER PUMP (GHNS and GHDS cars from Car No. 410002) Removing 1. Drain the cooling system, see Section C.9. 2. Disconnect the alternator multi-connector plug, 3. Remove the alternator securing bolts. 4, Remove the alternator and drive belt. 5. Slacken the retaining clip and disconnect the radiator bottom hose from the water pump 6. Remove the screws securing the water pump pulley 7. Remove the spacer and water pump pulley 8. Remove the bolts securing the water pump to the cylinder block. 9. Withdraw the water pump and joint washes Refitting 10, Reverse the procedure in 1 to 9, noting: MGB. a. Fit a new joint washer b. Torque tighten the water pump securing bolts to the figure given in “GENERAL DATA’ c. Adjust the drive belt tension to the figure given in ‘GENERAL DATA’. Issue 1. 91427 Section C.11 RADIATOR (GHNS and GHDS cars from Car No. 410002) Removing 1. Drain the cooling system, see Section C.9. 2. Slacken the hose clip and disconnect the top hose at the radiator. 3. Slacken the clip and disconnect the expansion tank hose from the radiator 4. Disconnect the thermostatic switch wites connector, Remove the screws securing the radiator to the mounting bracket 6. Slacken the screws securing the radiator mounting bracket ties to the bonnet Jock platform and swing the ties to one side. 7. fase the radiator towards the front of the vehicle and withdraw the radiator from the engine compartment, Refitting 8. Reverse the procedure in | to 7. Section C.12 FAN MOTOR (GHNS and GHDS cars from Car No. 410002) Removing 1. Remove the radiator fan guard from the bonnet lock platform, 2, Disconnect the fan motor wires at the multi-connector plug. 3. Slacken the grub screw retaining the fan blades to the motor spindle: Withdraw the fan blades off the spindle 5. Sucken the two screws clamping the fan motor bracket. 6, Withdraw the fan motor from the bracket Dismantling 7. Remove the two through-bolts. 8. Withdraw the end cover complete with armature from the motor yoke, noting the assembly marks on the end cover and yoke 9, Remove the citclip from the armature spindle and withdraw the two shims and the bowed washer. 10. , Withdraw the armature assembly from the end cover. 11. Withdraw the thrust washer from the armature spindle 12, Remove the citclip from the armature spindle. Remove the three serews to release the brush carrier assembly from the end cover. Inspection 14. Check the brush length, minimum length i& in (4.76 mm), renew the brush gear if necessary. If the brush leads are renewed, ensure that the black lead is connected to its correct brush and connector pin. att ( THE COOLING SYSTEM ancease Radiator fan motor components, 1. Assembly marks 5. Cirelip 9. Cirelip 2. Motor yoke 6. Thrust washer 10. Shims 3. Throush-bolts 7. tnd cover HL Brush carricr 4 Armature 8. Bowed washer 12. Scrows- brush carrier 15. Connect a 110-volt ac. supply with a 15-watt test lamp in circuit between the armature shaft and one of the commutator segments. If the test lamp lights, the ‘armature insulation is faulty and the armature must be renewed. 16. Check the armature inter-winding for short circuits, using Growler test equipment 17, Clean the commutator, using a petrol-moistened cloth: if necessary refinish the commutator, using very fine glass-paper. A badly burned or worn commutator should be skimmed lightly in a lathe. After skimming, clean the copper swarf from the inter-segment spacers. CAUTION: Do not undercut the commutator segments. Reassembling 18. Reverse the procedure in 5 to 14, noting: a, Lubricate sparingly the bearing bushes and the armature shaft bearing surfaces with Shell Turbo Al oil b. Ensure that the assembly marks on the yoke and the end cover are in line. c. Fit the bowed washer between the two shim washers. 4, Tighten the through-bolts to 14 Ibf in (0.17 kef m). 19, Test the fan motor, see Section C.13. Refitting 20. Reverse the procedure in 1 to 4, ensuring to fit the ‘motor to the mounting bracket so that the fan blades c12 end of the motor body protrudes 2 in (50.8 mm) from the mounting bracket Section C.13 FAN MOTOR TEST (GHNS and GHDS cars from Car No. 410002) Test 1, Remove the fan motor, see Section C.12. Slacken the grub screw and remove the fan blades, Connect the motor to a 13.5volt d.c. supply with a moving-coil ammeter in series and check that the motor light running current does not exceed 3 amps after 60 seconds from cold 4. Check that the light running speed is between 3,500 and 4,000 rev/min at 13.5V after 60 seconds from cold. + 5. If the motor current consumption and speed are low, a dirty commutator or faulty brush gear is indicated. 6. If the current consumption is high after the motor has been dismantled and reassembled, misalignment of the end cover bearing may be the cause, this can be corrected by applying 2 series of light blows to the side of the motor end cover only, using a hide or wooden mallet. If this does not correct high current consumption, a faulty armature is indicated. 7. Refit the fan blades. 8. Refit the fan motor. MGB. Issue 1. 91427 THE COOLING SYSTEM C Section C.14 THERMOSTAT (GHNS and GHDS cars from Car No. 410002) Removing 1 MG. Remove the coolant filler plug and ‘O” ring seal Remove the coolant drain plug from the cylinder block, partly drain, and refit the drain plug. Remove the nuts, spring and plain washers and release the water outlet pipe Remove the joint washer. Remove the thermostat from the cylinder head. Issue 1. 91427 Testing 6. If the thermostat is stuck in the open position it is, faulty and must be renewed 7. Place the thermostat in a container of water and heat the water, noting the water temperature at which the thermostat opens. The nominal temperature in deg. C At which the thermostat opens is stamped on the base of the thermostat bulb approximately the right thermostat If it does not open at temperature, renew the Refitting 8. Reverse the procedure in 1 to 5, noting: a. Use a new joint washer. b. Torque tighten the water outlet elbow nuts to the figure given in “GENERAL DATA’. C3 MGB. SECTION D THE FUEL SYSTEM +Air cleaners #Carburetters S.U.typeHS4 S.U. type HIFA Fuel pump (early cars). Fuel pump (GHNS and GHDS cars from Car No. 410002) oo Fuel tank Lubrication Throttle cable (GHNS and GHDS cars from Car No. 410002)... ‘Throttle pedal (GHNS and GHDS cars from Car No. 410002) + These operations must be followed by an exhaust emission check. Issue 8. 91427 SECTION Ds el D THE FUEL SYSTEM Section D.1 LUBRICATION Carburetters Unscrew the oil cap at the top of each suction chamber, top up with oil to within 4 in. (13 mm.) from the top of the hollow piston rod. Under no circumstances should a heavy-bodied lubricant be used. Failure to lubricate the piston dampers will cause the pistons to flutter and reduce acceleration. Section D.2 FUEL TANK Removing EARLY TOURER MODELS (10 gal. (12 US. gal.. 454 litres) ) Disconnect the battery and raise the cat to a workable height. Remove the hexagon drain plug and empty the tank. Slacken the two clips on the filler neck hose, withdraw the filler extension and seal. Disconnect the fuel pipe at the union and the fuel gauge cable from the tank unit, each on the right-hand side of the tank Support the tank and remove the two nuts from the bolts securing the straps at the rear of the tank to the anchorage brackets. ‘Swing away the straps and lower the tank. LATER TOURER AND GT MODELS (12 gal. (14 US. gal., 54.5 litres). Disconnect the battery and raise the car to a workable height Remove the hexagon drain plug and empty the tank. Slucken the two clips on the filler neck hose, withdraw the filler extension and seal. Disconnect the fuel pipe at the union and the fuel gauge cable from the tank unit, each on the right-hand side of the tank. Support the tank and from inside the luggage compartment remove the set screws securing the tank to the luggage compartment floor. Lower the tank Replacement is a reversal of the above instructions. Fuel gauge tank unit EARLY TOURER MODELS Remove the six set screws securing the unit to the tank and withdraw the tank unit, taking care not to strain or bend the float lever, When replacing, a new joint washer must be fitted and a sealing compound used to make a fueltight joint, LATER TOURER AND GT MODELS Remove the tank gauge locking ring with Service tool 18G 1001 and lift out the gauge assembly and rubber sealing ring, When refitting the gauge unit a new rubber sealing ring should be fitted if necessary to ensure a fuel-tight joint. D2 Section D.3 FUEL PUMP Removing and refitting ‘The fuel pump is mounted on a bracket secured to the heelboard adjacent to the front mounting right-hand rear spring, and is accessible from beneath the car. Disconnect the earth lead from the batteries and the earth and supply leads from the terminals on the pump. Disconnect the inlet and outlet pipe unions and the breather pipes (ater cars) Remove the two bolts securing the pump bracket to the heelboard, When refitting, reverse the removing procedure ensuring that the breather pipes are connected to the pump and correctly retained by the “T’ pieces in the harness grommets in the boot floor. Dismantling CONTACT BREAKER 1. Remove the insulated sleeve or knob, terminal nut, and connector, together with its shakeproof washer. Remove the tape seal and take off the end cover. 2. Unscrew the 5 B.A. screw which holds the contact blade to the pedestal and remove the condenser from its clip. This will allow the washer, the long coil lead, and the contact blade to be removed. COIL HOUSING AND DIAPHRAGM 3. Unscrew the coil housing securing screws, using a thick-bladed screwdriver to avoid damaging the screw heads, 4, Remove the earthing screw. 5. ROLLER TYPE. Hold the coil housing over a bench or receptacle to prevent the 11 brass rollers from being damaged or lost as they come free, unscrew the diaphragm assembly anti-clockwise until the armature spring pushes it free of the housing, GUIDE PLATE TYPE. Tum the back edge of the diaphragm and carefully lever the two end lobes of the armature guide plate from the recess in the coil housing, unscrew the diaphragm assembly anti-clockwise until the armgajre spring pushes it free of the housing, Remove the armature guide from the diaphragm assembly. PEDESTAL AND ROCKER 6. Remove the end cover seal washer, unscrew the terminal nut, and remove the lead washer. This will have flattened on the terminal tag and thread and is best cut away with cutting pliers or a knife. Remove the terminal tag spring washer. Unscrew the two 2 L.A. screws holding the pedestal to the coil housing, remove the earth terminal tag together with the condenser clip. Tip the pedestal and withdraw the terminal stud from the terminal tag. The pedestal may now be removed with the rocker mechanism attached. MGB. Issue 8. 91427 THE AUF 300 AND HP FUEL PUMP COMPONENTS i fo. Description No. Description No. Description £1. Coithousing 26. Spring washer. 51. Spring washer. $2. Anmature spring 27. Pedestal screw. 52. Set screw. 3. Impact washer. 28. End cove. 53. Outlet valve 4, Armature centralizing roller. 29. Shakeproof washer. 54. Valve cap. i 5. Diaphragm and spindle assembly. 30. _Lucar connector. 55. Fite i 6 Set screw. 3. Nut 56. Sealing washer. 7. Spring washer 32, Insulating sleeve 57. Inlet valve 8 Earth connector 33, Sealing band 58, Valvecap i 9. Set screw. 34. Vent valve 59. Clamp plate i 10. Rocker mechanism. 35. Gasket. } 60. Set screw J 11, Rocker pivot pin 36. Pump body. 61, Pump body. 12, Terminal tag. 37. Fire washer. 62. Fibre washer 13, Terminal tag. 38. Outlet connection. 63, Outlet connection i 14. Earth tg 39, Seating washer 64. Filter. 15, Terminal stu. *40. Diaphragm plat. 65. Washer. 16, Pedestal. 41, Plastic diaphragm bares. | AUF 66. Plog 17. Spring washer. +42, Rubber diaphragm 30067. Inet valve ae 18, Lead washer. 43, Rubber 0" ring Type, 68. Thin ibe washer. FP, 19, Terminal nt. "44. Spring end cap. 69. Outlet valve cage 20, Ena cover seal washer. *45. Diaphragm spring. 70. Outlet valve. 21, Contact blade +46, Delivery flow smoothing TL. Spring oip 22. Washer eee 72, Medium fbve washer 23. Contact blade screw. a 73. Outlet connetton. 24. Condenser. 48. Gasket 74. Gasket. 25. Condenser lip. 49. Inlet ir bottle cover. 75. Sandwich plate. a 50, ished washer J + arly pumps. {Delivery air botle (ater pumps). MGB. Issue 6. 69615 D3 D THE FUEL SYSTEM Fig. DA Fitting the rocker assembly’ to the pedestal, (Inset) the correct position of the centre togale spring 7. Push out the hardened steel pin which holds the rocker mechanism to the pedestal. BODY AND VALVES (type AUF 300) 8. Unscrew the two Phillips screws securing the valve clamp plate, remove the valve covers, valves, sealing washers, and filter NOTE.-Dismantling of the delivery flow smoothing device should only be undertaken if the operation of it is faulty, and if the necessary equipment for pressure-testing after assembly is available. On this understanding proceed as follows: 9, Remove the four 4 B.A, screws securing the delivery flow smoothing device vent cover, remove the cover, the diaphragm spring, rubber ‘O” rings, spring cap, diaphragm, barrier, diaphragm plate, and sealing washer. 10. Remove the single 2 b.A. screw securing the inlet air bottle cover, remove the cover and gasket. 11, Unscrew the inlet and outlet connections. BODY AND VALVES (type HP) 12. Remove the inlet union, the outlet union, the outlet valve cage, and the inlet valve disc. Remove the base plug and filter. Inspecting GENERAL If gum formation has occurred in the fuel used in the pump, the parts in contact with the fuel will have become coated with a substance similar to varnish. This has a strong, stale smell and will attack the neoprene diaphragm. Brass and steel parts so affected can be cleaned by being boiled in a 20 per cent. solution of caustic soda, dipped in a strong nitric acid solution, and finally washed in boiling water, Light alloy parts must be well soaked in methylated spirits and then cleaned. 1. Clean the pump and inspect for cracks, damaged joint faces, and threads. 2. Clean the filter with a brush and examine for fractures. Renew if necessary. 3. Examine the coil lead tags for security and the lead insulation for damage. 4. Examine the contact breaker points for signs of burning and pitting. If this is evident the rockers and spring blade must be renewed. 5. Examine the pedestal for cracks or other damage particularly to the narrow ridge on the edge of the rectangular hole on which the contact blade rests. 6, Examine the diaphragm for signs of deterioration, 7. Examine the non-return vent valve in the end cover for damage, and ensure that the small ball valve is free to move, TYPE AUF 300 8. Examine the plastic valve assemblies for kinks or damage to the valve plates. They can best be checked by blowing or sucking with the mouth. 9. Check that the narrow tongue on the valve cage which prevents the valve being forced out of position, has not been distorted but allows a valve lift of approximately 1 in. (1.6 mm.). 10. EARLY PUMPS: Examine the delivery flow smoothing device diaphragm, barrier, plate, spring, and spring cap for damage. 1f in doubt, renew the diaphragm. LATER PUMPS: Examine the delivery air bottle diaphragm, 11, Examine the inlet air bottle cover and gasket for damage. 12. Examine the valve recesses in the body for damage and corrosion. If it is impossible to remove the corrosion or if the recesses are badly pitted the body must be discarded, TYPE HP 13, Remove the circlip in the outlet valve cage and examine the inlet and outlet valve discs for signs of, wear. Scrap, if worn. 14. Examine the valve seat in the body and outlet valve cage for damage and corrosion. If it is impossible to remove the corrosion or if the seat is pitted the body or cage must be discarded. Fig. D2 the diaphragm. Unscrew until the rocker just ‘throws MGB. Issue 6. 69615 THE FUEL SYSTEM D Reassembling PEDESTAL AND ROCKER NOTE.--The steel pin which secures the rocker mechanism to the pedestal is specially hardened and must not be replaced by other than a genuine $.U. part. I. Invert the pedestal and fit the rocker assembly to it by pushing the steel pin through the small holes in the rockers and pedestal struts. Then position the centre toggle so that with the inner rocker spindle in tension against the rear of the contact point the centre toggle spring is above the spindle on which the white rollers run. This positioning is important to obtain the correct ‘throw-over’ action, It is also essential that the rockers are perfectly freé to swing on the pivot pin and that the arms are not binding on the legs of the pedestal. If necessary, rockers can be squared up with 4 pair of thin-nosed pliers, 2. Assemble the square-headed 2 B.A. terminal stud to the pedestal, the back of which is recessed to take the square head. 3. Assemble the 2 B.A. spring washer and put the terminal stud through the 2 B.A. terminal tag then fit the lead washer, and the coned nut with its coned face to the lead washer (this makes better contact than an ordinary flat washer and nut). Tighten the 2 B.A. nut and finally add the end cover seal washer. 4. Assemble the pedestal to the coil housing by fitting the two B.A. pedestal screws, ensuring that the condenser wire clip on the leftthand screw (9 o'clock position) is between the pedestal and the earthing tag. The spring washer is not fitted when a condenser is used. 5. Tighten the screws, taking care to prevent the earthing tag from turing as this will strain or break the earthing flex. Do not overtighten the screws or the pedestal will crack, Do not fit the contact blade at this stage. DIAPHRAGM ASSEMBLY 6. Place the armature spring into the coil housing with its large diameter towards the coil ‘493108, Fig. D3, Setting the correct relative position of blade and rocker contact points MGB. Issue 4. 15676 Fig. D4 Fitting the armature guide plate, (nset), levering one of the end lobes from the recess 7. Before fitting the diaphragm make sure that the impact washer (a small neoprene washer that fits in the armature recess) is fitted to the armature. Do not use jointing compound or dope on the diaphragm. 8. Fit the diaphragm by inserting the spindle in the coil and screwing it onto the threaded trunnion in the centre of the rocker assembly. 9. Screw in the diaphragm until the rocker will not “throw over’. This must not be confued with jamming the armature on the coil housing internal steps. 10. ROLLER TYPE. With the pump held with the rocker end downwards, turn back the edge of the diaphragm and fit the 11 brass rollers into the recess in the coil housing ‘On latertype rocker mechanisms with adjustable fingers fit the contact blade and adjust the finger settings as described under those headings, then carefully remove the contact blade. 11. With the pump held horizontally, slowly unscrew the diaphragm while at the same time actuating it, until the rocker just throws over. Unscrew the diaphragm until the holes are aligned, then unscrew it a further quarter of a turn (four holes). 12, ROLLER TYPE. Press the centre of the armature and fit the retaining fork at the back of the rocker assembly. BODY COMPONENTS (type AUF 300) 13, GUIDE PLATE TYPE. Turn back the edge of the diaphragm and insert one end lobe of the armature guide plate into the recess between the armature and the coil housing. Progressively position all four lobes, then commencing in the centre and finishing with the two end ones, press the lobes firmly into the recess 14, Note that the inlet valve recess in the body is deeper than the outlet recess to allow for the filter and extra washer. Screw in the inlet and outlet connections with their sealing rings. Assemble the outlet valve Ds D THE FUEL SYSTEM 9300 Fig. DS The rocker finger settings on modified rocker assemblies 1. Pedestal 4. Inner rocker. 2. Contact blade. 5. Trunnion. 3. Outer rocker. A= 035 in, (9 mm) 6. Coil housing. (070 in. (1.8 mm.) components into the outlet recess in the following order: first a joint washer, then the valve (tongue side downwards), then the valve cover. 15, Assemble the inlet valve into the recess as follows: first a joint washer, then the filter (dome side downwards), then another joint washer, followed by the valve assembly (tongue side uppermost), then the valve cover. 16. Take care that both valve assemblies nest down into their respective recesses, place the clamp plate on top of the valve covers and tighten down firmly on to the body with the two screws. Replace the inlet air bottle cover with its joint washer and tighten down the central screw. 17. EARLY PUMPS: Place the sealing washer in the bottom of the delivery flow smoothing device recess, follow this with the perforated diaphragm plate (dome side downwards), then the plastic barrier followed by the rubber diaphragm. insert the ‘O” section sealing ring into the recess and ensure that it seats evenly. Place the diaphragm spring (large end towards the vented cover) into the cover, place the spring end cap on to the small end of the spring, pass the assembly tool through the cover, spring, and end cap, turn the tool through 90°, and tension the spring. Finally, fit the cap and spring assembly on to the diaphragm, tighten the four retaining screws and release the assembly tool. LATER PUMPS: Place the sealing washer in the bottom of the delivery air bottle recess, place the plastic diaphragm, dome side downwards, then add the ‘O° section sealing ring and tighten down the cap with its four screws. BODY COMPONENTS (type HP) 18. Assemble the brass outlet valve disc to the outlet valve cage, making sure that the smooth face of the disc Dé faces the valve seat, retain it in position with the circlip, which must be located in its groove. The valve must rattle freely when the valve cage is shaken. 19. Drop the inlet valve disc, smooth face downwards, on to the inlet valve seat in the body of the pump, insert the thin fibre washer, drop the outlet valve cage in position and insert the medium fibre washer, then screw in the outlet union and tighten with a spanner. Fit the inlet union and filter. BODY ATTACHMENT (type AUF 300) 20. Fit the joint washer to the body, aligning the screw holes, and offer up the coil housing to the body, ensuring correct seating between them, 21, Line up the six securing serew holes, making sure that the cast lugs on the coil housing are at the bottom, and insert the six 2 B.A. screws finger tight. Fit the earthing screw with its Lucar connector. 22. ROLLER TYPE. Carefully remove the retaining fork from the rocker assembly and check that the rollers are correctly positioned. 23. Tighten the securing screws in diagonal sequence. BODY ATTACHMENT (type HP) 24. Place the sandwich plate joint gisket on the face of the body, lining up the holes in the body and washer, fit the sandwich plate (concave face to diaphragm) to the gasket on the body, again lining up the holes. 25. Offer up the coil housing to the body and sandwich plate and ensure correct seating between them, with the connections at the top and filter at the bottom, 26. Line up the six securing screw holes, making sure that the two cast lugs on the coil housing are at the bottom, and insert the six 2 B.A. screws finger tight. Fit the earthing screw with its Lucar connector. 90708 Fig. D6 The contact gap setting on earlier-type rocker assemblies 1. Pedestal 2 Contact blade. 3. Outer rocker, 4. Inner rocker, 5. Trunnion, 6. Coil housing. A = 030 in. (.8 mm.) MGB. Issue 4, 15676 ‘THE FUEL SYSTEM D 27. Remove the roller retaining fork carefully, making sure that the rollers retain their position; a displaced roller will cut the diaphragm. 28. Tighten the securing screws in sequence as they appear diametrically opposite each other. CONTACT BLADE 29. Fit the contact blade and coil lead to the pedestal with the 5 B.A. washer and screw, Place the condenser tag beneath the coil lead tag, 30. Adjust the contact blade so that the points on it are a little above the contact points on the rocker when the points are closed, also that when the contact points make or break one pair of points wipes over the centre line of the other in a symmetrical manner. The contact blade attachment screw slot allows a degree of adjustment. 31, Tighten the contact blade attachment screw when the correct setting is obtained, CONTACT GAP SETTINGS 32. Check that when the outer rocker is pressed on to the coil housing the contact blade rests on the narrow rib which projects above the main face of the pedestal. If it does not, slacken the contact blade attachment screw, swing the blade clear of the pedestal, and bend it downwards a sufficient amount so that, when re-positioned, it rests against the rib. (a) MODIFIED ROCKER ASSEMBLIES 33. Check the lift of the contact blade above the top of Fig. DT hy 2) ‘The AUF 390 type pump The HP type pump mounted ‘mounted on the 8.U. test, ‘on the S.U. test stand, stand (A) Hole .156 in. (4 mm.) dia. (A) Hole .187 to .192 in. (4.74 to.4.9 mm) dia. MGB. Issued. 69615 Ass724 Fig. DS ‘A checking rig for S.U, fuel pumps available from V.L. Churchill and Co. Ltd. The rig measures output in gallons of paraffin (Kerosene) per hour, against required suction and delivery heads 1. Pressure gauge. 2. Flow glass, the pedestal (A) (Fig. D.S) with a feeler gauge, bending the stop finger beneath the pedestal, if necessary, to obtain a lift of .0354.005 in. (.94.13 mm.). 34. Check the gap between the rocker finger and coil housing (B) (Fig. D.5) with a feeler gauge, bending the stop finger, if necessary, to obtain 2 gap of, 070.005 in, (1.8.13 mm.). (b) EARLIER-TYPE ROCKER ASSEMBLIES 35. Check the gap between the points indirectly by carefully holding the contact blade against the rib on the pedestal, without pressing against the tip (Fig D.6), then check if a .030 in. (8 mm.) feeler will pass between the fibre rollers and the face of the coil housing. if necessary, the tip of the blade can be set to correct the gap, END COVER 36. Ensure that the end cover seal washer is in position on the terminal stud, fit the bakelite end cover and shakeproof washer, and secure with the brass nut. Fit the terminal tag or connector and the insulated sleeve. After test, replace the rubber sealing band over the end cover gap and seal with adhesive tape. This must be retained when the pump is not mounted internally ina moisture-free region. Testing on a test stand PREPARATION 1. Churchill test rig Secure the pump in the clamping ring, with the outlet connection uppermost. Connect to a 12-volt battery, D7, D THE FUEL SYSTEM and with the switch in the ‘OFF’ position, clip the connector to the pump. Connect the delivery and return of the correct bore to the pump. SU. test rig: Mount the pump on the test stand, using the appropriate adaptor set according to the type of pump. Connect the feed and earth terminals to the test battery and check the contact gap setting as described under that heading. Replace the end cover with a cutaway one which allows observation of the rocker assembly while retaining the pivot pin, Use paraffin (kerosene) in the test tank, Ensure an adequate supply. PRIMING 2. Unscrew the regulator valve ( Churchill rig only) and switch on: the pump should prime ftom dry in 10 to 15 seconds. Allow the pump to run for a minute to stabilize the flow. AIR LEAK CHECK, 3. When the pumps first started air bubbles will be mixed with the liquid discharged from the pipe projecting downwards into the flow meter; these bubbles should cease after a minute or so. li they do not, an air leak is indicated either in the pump or the connecting unions, and this must be rectified VALVE SEAT CHECK 4. Let the pump run for about 10 minutes and then test as follows With the regulator valve (delivery tap) turned completely off the pump should stand without repeating for a minimum of 20 seconds at the correct delivery head. If it repeats, the inlet valve is not seating correctly. On AUF 300 type pumps malfunction of the inlet valve must be investigated. On HP-type pumps with metal valve discs this may be remedied by removing the discs and rubbing down the smooth face, using fine lapping paste on a smooth surface, or by dressing the valve seat. DELIVERY CHECK 5. Churchill: Obtain a delivery head reading of 4 feet (1220 mm.) on the gauge by adjusting the regulator valve on top of the flow glass. When correct, the pump flow rate may be read directly from the appropriate colour scale on the flow glass. S.U. The paraffin (kerosene) should rise in the glass ‘tube until it flows over the top of the pipe in which a side hole is drilled; if the output is not up to specification, the side hole will carry off all paraffin (kerosene) pumped and none will flow over the top. The maximum delivery should be timed as follows: AUF 300 type pump .. 1 pint in 30 sec. HP-type pump ~ Lpint in 1 min, 5 sec. MINIMUM DELIVERY CHECK 6. Check with the tap turned on only slightly, and also by pressing gradually inwards on the tip of the contact 8 blade, so as to reduce the effective stroke, that the Pump continues to work with an increasing frequency until it eventually stops because there is no gap left between the points. REDUCED VOLTAGE 7. Connect a resistance and voltmeter in circuit and test the pump at 9.5 volts with regulator valve open (tap full on); the pump should work satisfactorily although reduced output. SPARKING CHECK 8. Check for excessive sparking at the contact points. A moderate degree is permissible; excessive sparking would indicate that the special leak wire incorporated in the coil winding has fractured, necessitating a new coil unit, or that the condenser is faulty. Fuel pump faults 1. SUSPECTED FUEL FEED FAILURE Disconnect the fuel line at the carburetter and check for flow. (@)_ If normal, examine for obstructed float-chamber needle seating or gummed needle. (6) F normal initially, but diminishing rapidly and accompanied by slow pump operation, check for correct tank venting by removing the filler cap. Inadequate venting causes a slow power stroke with resultant excessive burning of contact points. (0) If reduced flow is accompanied by slow operation of the pump, check for any restriction on the inlet side of the pump, such as a clogged filter, which should be removed and cleaned. In the case of reduced flow with rapid operation of the pump, check for an air teak on the suction side, dirt under the valve, or faulty valve sealing washers. (@_ If no flow, check for: (ELECTRICAL SUPPLY Disconnect the lead from the terminal and check if current is available. (ii), FAULTY CONTACT POINTS If electrical supply is satisfactory, the bakelite cover should be removed to check that the tungsten points are in contact. The lead should then be replaced on the terminal and a short piece of bared wire put across the contacts. If the pump then performs a stroke, the fault is due to dirt or corrosion, or maladjustment of the tungsten points. The points may be cleaned by folding a small piece of fine emery-paper and inserting it between them and sliding it to and fro, To re-adjust the contact points follow the procedure laid down under the appropriate heading, (ii) OBSTRUCTED PIPELINE FUEL TANK AND PUMP The inlet pipe should be disconnected. If the pump then operates, the trouble is due MGB. Issue 4. 69615 BETWEEN THE FUEL SYSTEM D to a restriction in the pipeline between the pump and the tank. This may be cleared by the use of compressed air after removing the fuel tank filler cap. It should be noted, however, that compressed air should not be passed through the pump as this will cause serious damage to the valves. (iv) FAULTY DIAPHRAGM ACTION In the event of the previous operations failing to locate the trouble, it may be due to a stiffening of the diaphragm fabric or the presence of abnormal friction in the rocker ‘throw-over’ mechanism, or a combination of both. To remedy these faults the coil housing should be removed and the diaphragm flexed a few times, taking care not to lose any of the 11 rollers under the diaphragm. Prior to this resetting it is advisable to apply, very sparingly, a little thin oil to the throw-over spring spindles at the point where they pivot in the brass rockers. The diaphragm/armature assembly should then be reassembled in accordance with the instructions given under that heading, 2. NOISY PUMP If the pump is noisy in operation, an air leak at the suction line may be the cause. Such a leak may be checked by disconnecting the fuel pipe ftom the carburetter and allowing the pump to discharge into a suitable container with the end of the pipe submerged. The emission of € 7 Fig. DS The HS4 carburetter 1. Jet adjusting nut 5. Float-chamber securing nut 2. Throttle stop screw. 6. Jet link, 3. Choke or fast-idle screw. 7. Jet head. 4, Jet locking nut. 8, Vacuum ignition take-off. MGB. Issue S. 69615 ti alass 3 4 Asa7e Fig, D10 A sectional view of the HS4 carburetter 1. Jet locking nut, 2 Jet adjusting nut 3. Jet head 4. Peed tube from float- chamber, 5. Piston lifting pin, 6. Needle securing screw. 7. Oil damper reservoir. continuous bubbles at this point will confirm the existence of an air leak, The fault should be rectified by carrying out the following procedure: (@) Check that all connections from the fuel tank to the pump are in good order. (>) Check that the inlet union is tight and that the sealing ‘O’ ring is not damaged. (©) Check that the coil housing securing screws are well and evenly tightened. Air leaks on the suction side cause rapid operation of the pump and are the most frequent cause of permanent failure. 3, PUMP OPERATES WITHOUT DELIVERING FUEL If the pump operates continuously without delivery of fuel the most likely causes are: (a) _A very serious air leak on the suction side or, (b) Foreign matter lodged under one of the valves, particularly the inlet valve. To remedy (a) see Section 2 (above). In order to remove any foreign matter lodged under the valves, these should be removed for cleaning and great care taken that the plastic material of the valve disc is not scratched or damaged during this operation. Dg 10 Suds —s04s0q 0}-H108 *unesedo 940U>—19007 "109-108 1042945091 ana]-1108 anguea seat kiqunasse ud pure 19497] “somamgiea 101s Ayquisse uid pu 19697 “Aunaeuu0d raf Port ‘ours P2456 204 v0ard—Buads—1ays094 109 yowd-aqn, sroad-oq nga seat—s9nay wrea—Buds yamqze> }U03}—soAa) wre—Fuds seqyamqit 1ea1— sana dasjord-Bursds sovyeunqito Wuory—Za49] dnjond—Bsds anges 28a1~ ure>—19497] yeung3¥9 IOs} — we Z049, af 0} uH—max9g aingres sea1—dneqoqd—Aqquiosse yun] put 138977 wondisosaq z Ww 0 69 89 19 “99 ‘89 9 9 7° 19 09 6s 8s us 95 ‘ss os es 1s ow ON uo1s—dnoford— Ayquiosse Ur oF “sb dows omonn—mon0§ “ry “moras dots op ‘mu—qeI—FOUsEN “EP 3OAII-TON Th tujoede—soyseg “Ty ‘uomow 1801-29801 “OF ssmamnqrea e9s—u 6 vaasngit9 1woH}—wnI91 9NVOsIp—H0H9T “BE ue “9 vonyp-oqpurds. “se “motos SUAdS—2OUS0M “FE pi-mans “ee “Arquiasse yas pue apeeN, “ze Pa-soumey “Te unqaeo rear—saquIEySseOUI—P1 “OE Jainqies uos}—saqUEYDIeOU-PT“6e “xonay pafumy—ulg-8z ‘AQuuasse YOY“ LZ Surny saqueypseoy—rog “97 cued—s24sem “Sz wor disoq. “ON SINANOdNOD YALLAUNGUVD FHL OL AT 1994) 204A (4aqqnu) soromnqzes 1e91—rounu011) (@2qqni) reamqreo yuo3y—rouN09 “odds saysey “rwoys—roquseyD “IPN tunsnipe rof—aonog “Bury20} 12f-Bunsdg “Buryo0] 19f-oHs soqyoanqae ar 4]qUuasse 195 —Ayquasse 12 (pa) woid—Bunds (asqy) deo—iayseg “Ayquuosse siodurep pue de) ‘Burypo] apseu—marog -Aquiosse uosstd pure xoquiey “uyd—aqjo9, -wyd—funds fun voisd—ug oy nq7e9 193-40 sayjamngzes 1U01}—Apog, ond 2d DAL 86842 Issue 6. MGB. D THE FUEL SYSTEM Fig. DLL (Checking the nylon float level Ad tod in, (3.18 t0 4.76 mm.) C. Float lever resetting point. ‘ia, bar D. Needle valve assembly. B. Machined lip E. Bingo pin. Section D.4 CARBURETTERS (S.U. type HS4) =~ | IMPORTANT.-The instructions given in this section for adjusting, dismantling and reassembling the carburetters applies only to cars not fitted with exhaust emission control equipment. Carburetters fitted to cars with exhaust emission control equipment must be tuned and serviced in accordance with the instructions given in Workshop Manual Supplement AKD 4957. Removing and refitting Release the spring clips and detach the breather hose between the air cleaner and rocker cover (early cars). Disconnect the fuel supply pipe at the rear carburetter or at each carburetter float-chamber. Disconnect the overflow pipes. Slacken off the bolt and nut securing the mixture and throttle cables respectively and withdraw the cables complete. Detach the throttle return springs. Pull off the rubber connection for the vacuum ignition control pipe from the top of the rear carburetter body. Remove the four nuts securing the carburetter flanges and withdraw the carburetters and air cleaners as an assembly. When refitting, the centre throttle return spring end eye is located between the flat washer and the throttle lever. The throttle linkage must be checked, and readjusted if necessary, after refitting. ‘Slow-running adjustments and synchronization As the needle size is determined during engine development, tuning of the carburetters is confined to correct idling setting. Run the engine until it attains its normal running ‘temperature. Slacken off the pinch-bolt of one of the coupling levers locating the carburetter interconnecting shaft to the carburetter throttle spindles so that each carburetter can be operated independently. Disconnect the mixture control cable and slacken off the two pinch-bolts to free the choke actuating lever and unscrew the fastidling screws. Remove the pistons and suction chambers. Screw the jet adjusting nuts until each jet is flush with the bridge of its carburetter, or as near to this as possible (each jet being in the same relative position to the bridge of its respective carburetter). Replace the pistons and suction chamber assemblies, and check that the pistons fall freely onto the bridge of the carburetters (by use of the piston lifting pins). Turn down the jet adjusting nut two complete turns (12 flats). Restart the engine, and adjust the throttle adjusting screws to give the desired idling speed by moving each throttle adjusting screw an equal amount, By listening to the hiss in the intake, adjust the throttle adjusting screws until the intensity of the hiss is similar on each intake. This will synchronize the throttle setting When this is satisfactory the mixture should be adjusted by screwing each jet adjusting nut up or down by the same amount until the fastest idling speed is obtained consistent with even firing. During this adjusting it is necessary that the jets are pressed upwards to ensure that they are in contact with the adjusting nuts. As the mixture is adjusted the mixture will probably run faster, and it may therefore be necessary to unscrew the throttle adjusting screws a little, each by the same amount, to reduce the speed. Now check the mixture strength by lifting the piston of the tear carburetter by approximately a in. (.75 mm.), when: 1. If the engine speed increases, the mixture strength of the rear carburetter is too rich. 2. af the engine speed immediately decreases, the mixture strength of the rear carburetter is too weak. Fig, D.12 ‘A feeler gauge between the throttle shaft stop and the choke interconnecting spindle. Inset shows the position for the feeler gauge on the cars fitted with automatic transmission MGB. Issue 6. 86842 THE FUEL SYSTEM D 3. If the engine speed momentarily increases very slightly, the mixture strength of the rear carburetter is correct. Repeat the operation at the front carburetter, and after adjustment recheck the rear carburetter, since the carburetters are interdependent. When the mixture is correct the exhaust note should be regular and even. If it is irregular, with a splashy type of, misfire and colourless exhaust, the mixture is too weak. If there is a regular or rhythmical type of misfire in the exhaust beat, together with a blackish exhaust, then the mixture is too rich. The carburetter throttle on each carburetter is operated by a lever and pin, with the pin working in a forked lever attached to the throttle spindle. A clearance exists between the pin and the fork which must be maintained when the throttle is closed and the engine idling, to prevent any load from the accelerator linkage being transferred to the throttle butterfly and spindle. To set the clearance on synchromesh cars, with the throttle shaft levers free on the throttle shaft, place a .12 in, (3 mm.) feeler gauge between the throttle shaft stop and the choke interconnecting rod (see Fig. D.12). On cars fitted with automatic transmission place a .020 in (.5 mm.) feeler gauge between the throttle lever and the throttle lever stop (inset, Fig. 12). Move each throttle shaft lever downwards in turn until the lever pin rests lightly on the lower arm of the forkin the carburetter throttle lever. Tighten the clamp bolt of the throttle shaft lever at this position. When both carbu- rettershave been dealt with, remove the feeler gauge. The pins on the throttle shafts should then have clearance in the forks. Reconnect the choke cable, ensuring that the jet heads return against the lower face of the jet adjusting nuts and that the choke actuating levers are fully returned when the choke control is pushed fully in. Pull out the mixture control knob on the dash panel until the linkage is about to move the carburetter jets (a minimum of % in, or 6 mm,) and adjust the fastidle adjusting screws to give an engine speed of about 1,000 p.m. when hot. A small clearance must be maintained between the fast-idle cams and the abutment screws when the mixture control is pushed fully in. Jetcentring To check the jet for concentricity with the jet needle set the jet head and the jet adjusting nut in the uppermost position, lift the suction piston with the piston lifting pin, and allow the piston t6 fall. It should fall freely, and a definite soft, metallic click will be heard as the base of the piston strikes the jet bridge Ki this does not happen with the jet raised, but does occur when the’ jet is lowered, the jet bearing and jet must be recentred as follows. Disconnect the lever between the interconnecting lever and the jet head. Unscrew the union holding the nylon feed tube into the ‘base of the float-chamber and withdraw the tube and jet together. MGB. Issue S. 86842 Unscrew the jet adjusting nut and remove the lock spring; screw up the nut to its fullest extent and refit the jet head and feed tube. Slacken off the jet locking mit until the jet bearing is just free to rotate with finger pressure. Remove the piston damper from the top of the suction chamber and gently press the piston down onto the jet bridge. Tighten the jet locking nut, at the same time ensuring that the jet head is still in its correct angular position. Lift the piston and check that it falls freely and evenly, hitting the jet bridge with a soft, metallic click, with the jet in the raised and lowered position, If the result is not satisfactory and the piston is not sticking, the recentring operation must be repeated until the correct result is obtained. When the operation is complete replace the adjusting nut lock spring and the jet operating lever. The adjustment is best effected with the carburetters removed from the engine, Float-chamber The position of the hinged float lever must be such that the level of the float (and therefore the height of the fuel at the jet) is correct. To check the float-level, hold the float-chamber lid and float assembly upside-down and place a # in, (3.18 mm.) diameter bar across the diameter of the machined lip of the float-chamber lid, parallel to the float lever hinge pin and under the float lever (see Fig. D.11). The face of the float lever should just rest on the bar when the float needle is held fully on its seating. If this is not so, carefully reset the angle made between the straight portion of the float lever and its hinge until the correct position is obtained Float-chamber flooding This is indicated by the fuel dripping from the drain pipe, and is generally caused by grit between the float-chamber needle and its guide. This is cured by removing the float-chamber, washing the valve and float-chamber components, and reassembling. Float needle sticking If the engine stops, apparently through lack of fuel, when there is plenty in the tank and the pump is working properly, the probable cause is a sticking float needle. An easy test for this is to disconnect the pipe from the electric: pump to the carburetters and switch the ignition on and off quickly while the end of the pipe is directed onto a pad of cloth or into a container. If fuel is delivered, starvation is almost certainly being caused by the float needle sticking to its seating, and the float-chamber lid should therefore be removed and the needle and seating cleaned and refitted. At the same time it will be advisable to clean out the entire fuel feed system as this trouble is caused by foreign matter in the fuel, and unless this is removed it is likely to recur. It is of no use whatever renewing any of the component parts of either carburetter, and the only cure is to make sure that the fuel D.13 D THE FUEL SYSTEM tank and pipe lines are entirely free from any kind of foreign matter or sticky substance capable of causing this trouble. a Needles Remove the piston and suction chamber assembly. Slacken the needle clamping screw, extract the needle and check its identifying mark (see ‘GENERAL DATA’). Refit the correct needle, ensuring that the shoulder on the shank is flush with the piston base. Piston sticking ‘The piston assembly comprises the suction disc and the piston forming the choke, into which is inserted the hardened and ground piston rod which engages in a bearing in the centre of the suction chamber and in which is, in turn, inserted the jet needle. The piston rod running in the bearing is the only part which is in actual contact with any other part, the suction disc, piston and needle all having suitable clearances to prevent sticking. If sticking does ‘occur the whole assembly should be cleaned carefully and the piston rod lubricated with a spot of thin oil. No oil must be applied to any other part except the piston rod. A sticking piston can be ascertained by removing the piston damper and lifting the piston by pressing the piston lifting pin; the piston should come up quite freely and fall back smartly onto its seating when released. On no account should the piston return spring be stretched ot its tension altered in an attempt to improve its rate of return. Section D.5 AIR CLEANERS The air intake filters are of the dry paper element type requiring no attention between filter replacement. The air filter casings should be removed and cleaned out periodically to remove any dust deposit. Filter replacement Disconnect the engine rocker cover breather pipe from the front filter (early cars). Unscrew the bolts securing each air filter to the choke bracket and fixing plate respectively and remove the filters from the vehicle complete. Remove the base plate and throw away the old paper clement. Clean the inside casing and intake tubes thoroughly and reassemble, using new paper elements. Section D.6 CARBURETTERS (S.U. Type HIF4) IMPORTANT: The instructions given in this section for adjusting, dismantling and reassembling the carburetters apply only to cars not fitted with exhaust emission control equipment. Carburetters fitted to cars with exhaust D4 emission control equipment must be tuned and serviced in accordance with the instructions given in Workshop Manual ‘Supplement AKD 4957. Tuning/adjust Before tuning the carburetters in an endeavour to rectify poor engine performance, check the following items to ensure that the maladjustment or fault is not from another souree. a. Valve clearance b. Spark plug condition c. Contact breaker (dwell angle) Ignition timing and advance e. Presence of air leaks in the induction system f. Operation of engine controls. g Compression pressures Carburetter tuning is confined to setting the idle and fast idle speeds, and mixture at idle speed. To achieve the best results, a reliable tachometer, a balancing meter and an exhaust gas analyser (CO meter of the infra-red non-dispersive type or equivalent) are required. The instruments are essential when tuning vehicles equipped to conform with exhaust emission regulations. 1, Remove the air cleaners as detailed in Section D.5. 2. Check the throttle for correct operation and signs of sticking 3. Unscrew each throttle adjusting screw until it is just clear of the throttle lever stop when the throttle is closed, then tum each screw one turn in a clockwise direction. 4, Raise the piston of each carburetter, using the lifting pin, and check that the piston falls freely onto the bridge in the carburetter body when the lifting pin is released. If the piston tends to stick, the carburetter must be serviced. 5. Remove the suction chamber assembly, and lift the piston clear of the bridge, so that the jet is visible. 6. Tur the jet adjusting screw of each carburetter until each jet is flush with the bridge in the carburetter body or as high as possible without exceeding the bridge height. Ensure that both jets are in the same relative position to the bridge of their respective carburetter. 7. Check that the shoulder of each needle is flush with the underside of its respective piston. 8. Tum the jet adjusting screw of each carburetter two tums clockwise. 9. Turn the fast idle adjusting screw of each carburetter in an anti-clockwise directioh until it is well clear of its fast idle cam. 10, Refit the suction chamber assembly. 11. Unscrew and withdraw the piston dampers from the suction chambers. Top up with new engine oil (preferably S.A.E. 20) until the level is ¥ in. (13 mm.) above the top of each hollow piston rod (see Fig. D.13).. Refit the damper assemblies. MGB. Ise 5, 86842 THE FUEL SYSTEM D Fig D.13 Carburetter tuning ($.U. HIF4) 12. Connect the tachometer of tool 18G 677 % to the engine 13. Start the engine and run it at a fast idle until it attains normal running temperature, then run it for a further five minutes. 14, Increase the engine speed to 2,500 r.p.m. for 30 seconds. 15. Connect an exhaust gas analyser to the engine in accordance with the instrument manufacturers instructions. Setting can now commence. If the correct setting cannot be obtained within three minutes, increase the engine speed to 2,500 1.p.m. for 30 seconds and then recommence tuning. Repeat this clearing operation at three minute intervals until tuning is completed. 16, Slacken both clamping bolts on the throttle spindle interconnections. 17. Slacken both clamping bolts on the cold start interconnection. MGB. Issue 1. 86842 1. Throttle adjusting screw 8. Bridge. 14, Cold start interconnection rod, 2. Piston lifting pin. 9. Jet 15. Cold start interconnection rod lover 3. Fast idle adjusting screw. 10, Piston clamp bolts 00 mn _ 16, Clearance of 0.012 in (0,31 mm) pee alee between throttle lever pin and lower 5. Jet adjusting serew. 12, Throttle inter-connection rod. arm of throttle fork. 6. Piston damper. 13, Throttle inter-connection rod lever 17. Fast idle cam positioned for fast idle 17. Piston rod. clamp bolts. adjustment, 18. Using a balance meter in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions, balance the carburetters, altering the throttle adjusting screws until the correct idle speed (see ‘ENGINE TUNING DATA’) and balance is achieved. Alternatively, use a ‘listening tube’ to compare the intensity of the intake hiss from both carburetters and alter the throttle adjusting screws until the hiss from both carburetters is the same at idling speed. 19. Turn the jet adjusting screw of each carburetter by the same amount, clockwise to enrich or anti-clockwise to weaken, until the fastest engine speed is indicated on the tachometer; turn each adjusting screw anti-clockwise by the same amount until the engine speed just commences to fall. Tur each screw very slowly clockwise by the minimum but same amount until the maximum engine speed is regained. 20. Check the engine idling speed and readjust it as necessary, tuming each throttle adjusting screw by the same amount. DAS THE FUEL SYSTEM a 22. 1. Throttle cable retaining aut 2. Choke cable retaining screw. 3. Breather pipe. 4, Fuel feed hose. 5. Vent hose. Using the exhaust gas analyser, check that the carbon monoxide percentage is within the limits given in ‘ENGINE TUNING DATA’. If the reading falls outside the limits, reset both jet adjusting screws by the same but minimum amount necessary to bring the reading just within the limits. If an adjustment exceeding half a tum is required to achieve this, the carburetters must be removed and serviced. Stop the engine and set the throttle interconnection rod levers so that a clearance of 0.012 in, (0,31 mm.) exists between each lever link pin and the lower arm of its respective throttle lever fork. a. Insert a 0.012 in. (0.31 .mm,) feeler gauge lever between the throttle interconnection rod stop lever and the cold start interconnection rod, b. Move each throttle interconnection lever downwards until each lever link pin rests on the lower arm of its respective throttle lever fork. Tighten the throttle interconnection rod lever clamp bolts, ensuring that the throttle interconnection rod has an end-float of, approximately 1/32 in, (0.8 mm.). Remove the feeler gauge. D.16 Fig Dad Carburetter installation (S.U. HIF4) 6 1 8. 9, 10. 2B. 25. 26. 21. 28, Distributor vacuum pipe Return springs. Carburetter securing nuts. Insulation block. Heat shield, Run the engine at 1,500 r.p.m. and recheck the carburetter balance to ensure that the throttle linkage is connected correctly. Ensure that the fast idle cam lever of each carburetter is against its respective stop and tighten the cold start interconnection rod lever clamp bolts so that both cam levers begin to move simultaneously when the mixture control is operated, Ensure that the fast idle cam lever of each carburetter is against its respective stop and check that the mixture control cable has 1/16 in, (1.5 mm,) free movement before it commences to operate the cam levers. Pull out the mixture control (choke) until the arrow marked on the cam is positioned under the fast idle adjusting screw. Run the engine and using the balance meter or “tistening tube’ to ensure equal adjustment, turn the fast idle adjusting screws to set the engine fast idling to the speed given in ‘ENGINE TUNING DATA’. Refit the air cleaners. MGB. Issue 1 86842 THE FUEL SYSTEM Removing 29. Remove the air cleaners as detailed in Section D.S. 30. Disconnect the throttle cable from the interconnection lever. 31. Disconnect the choke cable. 32. Disconnect the breather pipes from the carburetter adaptors. 33, Disconnect the fuel feed hose from the float chamber adaptor. 34, Disconnect the vent hoses from the carburetter adaptor. 35, Disconnect the distributor vacuum hose from the carburetter adaptor. 36. Disconnect the retum springs from the heat shield. 37. Remove the four nuts securing the carburetters to the inlet manifold studs. 38. Lift the carburetter assembly off.the inlet manifold studs, Dismantling 39. Thoroughly clean the outside of the carburetter. 40. Remove the piston damper and its washer. 41, Mark the suction chamber to ensure it is refitted to the same body. 42. Unscrew the suction piston chamber retaining screws and remove the identity tag 43, Lift the suction chamber vertically from the body without tilting the chamber. 44, Remove the piston spring, lift out the piston assembly and empty the oil from the piston rod. 45, Unscrew the needle guide locking screw. 46, Withdraw the needle, guide and spring 47, Mark the bottom cover-plate and body to ensure correct reassembly, unscrew the retaining screws and remove the cover complete with sealing ring, 48. Remove the jet adjusting screw complete with ‘0 ring, 49, Remove the jet adjusting lever retaining screw and spring, 50. Withdraw the jet complete with adjusting lever, and disengage the lever. 51. Remove the float pivot spindle and fibre washer. Withdraw the float. 52. Remove the needle valve and unscrew the valve seat. 53. Unscrew the jet bearing locking nut and withdraw the bearing complete with fibre washer. 54, Note the location of the ends of the fast idle cam lever retum spring. 55. Unlock and remove the cam lever retaining nut and locking washer. 56. With the return spring held towards the carburetter body, prise off the cam lever and remove the retum, spring, 57. Unscrew the starter unit retaining screws and remove the cover-plate. 58. Withdraw the starter unit assembly and remove its gasket 59. Withdraw the valve spindle and remove the ‘O” ring, seals and dust cap. 60. Note the location and loading of the ends of the MGB. Issue 1. 86842 62. 63. 65. throttle lever return spring and remove the spring Unlock and remove the nut and tab washer retaining the throttle levers. Remove the throttle lever and throttle actuating lever. Remove the throttle disc retaining screws. Close the throttle and mark the position of the throttle disc in relation to the carburetter flange. Do not mark the disc in the vicinity of the over-run valve. Open the throttle and carefully withdraw the disc from the throttle spindle taking care not to damage the overrun valve. Withdraw the throttle spindle and remove its seals, noting the way it is fitted in relation to the carburetter body. Inspection 66. 67. 68. 69. 70. n. n. pope Examine the throttle spindle and its bearings in the carburetter body; check for excessive play, and renew Parts as necessary. Examine the float needle and seating for damage and excessive wear; renew if necessary. Examine all rubber seals and ‘O° rings for damage and deterioration; renew as necessary. The cover-plate sealing ring must be renewed. Check condition of all fibre washers and gaskets; renew as necessary. Clean the inside of the suction chamber and piston rod guide with fuel or denatured alcohol (methylated spirit) and wipe dry. Abrasives must not be used. Examine the carburetter body for cracks and damage and for security of the brass connections and the piston key Examine the suction chamber and piston for damage and signs of scoring. ey ist} SITET Gi a Se: LE LIZZIE, — B INC 2046, Pig D.AS Suction chamber timing check (8.U. HIF) Piston, 5. ‘Suction chamber. 6 Plugs in piston transfer holes Nut and bolt with large washer overlapping suction chamber bore. Damper. ‘Time for suction chamber to fall full extent of piston = 4't06 seconds. DAT THE FUEL SYSTEM 1 2. Jet bearing. 3. Jet bearing nut. 4, Jet assembly, 5. Lifting pin. 6. Lifting pin spring 1. Cirelip, 8. Adjusting screw seal 9. Jet adjusting screw. 10, Bi-metal jet lever. 11, Jet spring. 12, Jet retaining screw. 13, Needle seat washer Gt required), 14, Float needle seat. 15, Float needle Float pivot 18, Pivot seal 19. Float-chamber cover seal DAs The s. 20, 2 22. 23, 24, 2s, 26. 21. 28. 29, 30. 31 32. 33, 34. 35, 36, 31, 38. U, Fig. D.16 type HIF carburetter components Float-chamber cover Spring washer. Cover screw. Piston damper. Damper washer, ‘Suction chamber. Chamber screw. Identity tag Piston. Jet needle. Needle guide, Piston spring. Needle retaining screw, Needle spring. Throttle spindle sea, Throttle dise serews Throttle spindle. Throttle disc. Throttle spindle seal 39, 40, 4 22 43, 44. 45, 46. 47. 48 49, 30, ‘Throttle actuating lever. Fast idle serew and nut. Throttle lever. Throttle adjusting screw and nut. Tab washer. Retaining nut ‘Throttle spring Body. Cold start seal. Cold start spindle. “O' ring, Cold start body. - Spindle seal End cover. Retaining plate Cold start spring . Retaining screw. 5. Fast idle cam, Tab washer. Retaining nat. MGB. Issue 1. 86842 THE FUEL SYSTEM NOTE: It is only ne Fig D.A7 Carburetter reassembling (8.U. HIF) 1. Checking that the point of the float (arrowed) is, 0.04 + 0.02 in, (1.00.5 mm.) below the level of the float chamber face. essary to carry out the following timing check if the cause of the carburetter malfunction which necessitated the dismantling has not been located. 73. Temporatily plug the piston transfer holes. 74, Fit the piston into the suction chamber without its spring. 75. Fit @ nut and screw, with a large flat washer under the screw head, into one of the suction chamber fixing holes, positioning the washer so that it overlaps the chamber bore. 76. Fit the damper and washer. 77. Check that the piston is fully home in the suction chamber, invert the assembly to allow the chamber to fall away until the piston contacts the washer. 78. Check the time taken for the chamber to fall the full extent of the piston travel; the time taken should be 4 to 6 seconds. 79. WE the times are exceeded, check the piston and suction chamber for cleanliness and damage. If after rechecking the time is still not within these limits, renew the suction chamber and piston assembly. Reassembling 80. Reverse the procedure in 39 to 79, noting the follo’ MGB. ing he throttle spindle must be fitted with the threaded end at the piston lifting pin side of the body. Ensure that the throttle disc is fitted in its original position; over-run valve at the top of the bore and its spring towards the inside of the carburetter when the throttle is closed. Issue 2. 91427 a § piston. showing 2. Needle guide etch mark aligned correctly with ston transfer holes. shoulder of needle aligned with underside face of New throttle dise retaining screws must be used when refitting the disc. Ensure that the throttle disc is correctly positioned and closes correctly, before tightening the retaining screws. Spread the split ends of the screws sufficiently to prevent tuming, Position the throttle spindle end seals just below the spindle housing flange. The starter unit valve is fitted with the cut-out towards the top retaining screw hole and its, retaining plate is positioned with the slotted flange towards the throttle spindle. When fitting the jet assembly to the adjusting lever ensure that the jet head moves freely in the bimetal cut-out, After fitting the float and valve, invert the carburetter so that the needle valve is held in the shut position by the weight of the float only. Check that the point indicated on the float (see illustration) is 0.044 0.02 in. (1.040. mm.) below the level of the float-chamber face. Adjust the float position by carefully bending the brass pad. Check that the float pivots correctly about the spindle. Check that the small diameter of the jet adjusting screw engages the slot in the adjusting lever and set the jet flush with the bridge of the body. Use a new retaining screw when refitting the needle and ensure that the needle guide etch ‘mark aligns correctly with the piston transfer holes (see illustration). After fitting the needle assembly, check that the shoulder of the needle aligns the under-side face of the piston. D9 D THE FUEL SYSTEM Refitting 81. Reverse the procedure in 29 to 38, noting the following a. Fit new joint washers on each side of the distance pieces and between the heat shield and the manifold. b. Check and adjust the carburetter settings as detailed in'Tuning/adjust’ Section D.7 THROTTLE PEDAL, (GHNS and GHDS cars from Car No. 410002) Removing 1, Remove the split pin from the end of the throttle pedal Release the throttle cable from the throttle pedal. 3. Remove the throttle pedal pivot bolt. 4. Withdraw the throttle pedal from the vehicle. ng 5. Reverse the procedure in 1 to 4. Section D.S THROTTLE CABLE (GHNS and GHDS cars from Car No. 410002) Removing 1, Remove the securing clip and withdraw the clevis pin and washers to release the throttle cable from the throttle interconnection rod 20 2. Unscrew the lower nut on the throttle cable adjuster. Release the throttle cable from the abutment bracket. 4, Remove the screw to release the throttle cable retaining clip from the pedal bracket assembly. 5. Remove the split pin from the throttle pedal, 6. Release the throttle cable from the throttle pedal and withdraw the cable into the engine compartment. Refitting 7. Reverse the procedure in 1 to 6. Section D.9 FUEL PUMP (GHINS and GHDS cars from Car No. 410002) Removing Disconnect the battery. Open the luggage compartment lid 3. Remove the fuel pump guard retaining screws 4. Remove the fuel pump guard 5. Slacken the clip retaining the pump in the support rubber. 6. Disconnect the lead from the terminal on the pump. 7. From beneath the car disconnect the inlet and outlet pipe unions. 8. Disconnect the breather pipe. 9. Disconnect the lead from the terminal on the pump. 10. Withdraw the pump from the support rubber Refitting IL, Reverse the procedure in 1 to 10, ensuring that the inlet and outlet pipe unions face upwards at an angle of 45° inclined to the centre line of the pump. MGB. Issue 2. 91427 Da SECTION Da THE FUEL SYSTEM (EVAPORATIVE LOSS) ‘The information given in this Section refers specifically to service operations on, or affected by, equipment fitted to the MGB (GHNS and GHDS) in conformity with local and territorial requirements. SECTION Expansion tank . 5 oO o eo Dad Fuel tank (12 US. gallons, 45.4litres) Cae zy ~ Dal Leaktesting oe Da3 MGB, Issue 1. 25729 Da.l Da THE FUEL SYSTEM Section Da.1 Section Da.2 FUEL TANK VAPOUR SEPARATOR TANK . Removing Removing 1. Remove the spare wheel 2. Disconnect the battery (negative earth) and drain the fuel tank, 3. Slacken the two hose clips securing the rubber hose to the tank fuel inlet pipe and filler tube. 4, Remove the screw, large plain washers and sealing washers securing the tank inside the boot. 5. Underneath the car, disconnect the petrol feed pipe and gauge unit electrical connections. 6. Remove the nuts and washer retaining the tank lip to the four studs. Release the two vapour pipe clips and move the pipe to one side. 7. Remove the tank, Refitting 8. Reverse the removing procedure | to 7. Da2 1, Disconnect the battery. 2. Remove the two flexible pipe connections from the tank, Remove the screw, nut and washer retaining the tank. 3. Remove the tank, Caution.-Under extreme operating conditions the tank may contain fuel, Refitting 4. Reverse the removing procedure 1 to 3. Section Da.3 LEAK TESTING If a fault in the operation of the Evaporative Loss Control System is suspected or components of the system other than the filters or canister have been removed and refitted, the system must be pressure-tested in accordance with the test procedure given in Workshop Manual Supplement AKD 4957. MGB. Issue. 25729 SECTION E THE CLUTCH SECTION Description Bleeding the system ee oa ee BS Clutch assembly... a Ell Master cylinder .. . ae ~ we BB Servicing the clutch re . ~ B2 Slave cylinder See eee B4 MGB. Issue 3. 25729 E2 THE CLUTCH COMPONENTS Description Cover assembly. Cover with straps, diaphragm spring and release plate. Plate—pressure Bolt—strap. Clip-pressure plate. Description Washer—tab. Plate assembly~driven. Bearing assembly release. Retainer bearing. Screw-cluteh to flywheel Washer for serew—spring, MGB. Issue 3. 25729 THE CLUTCH E GENERAL DESCRIPTION The clutch mechanism is hydraulically operated and consists of a driven plate, a pressure plate, and a diaphragm spring and cover assembly. The cover is bolted to the flywheel and encloses the driven plate, pressure plate, and diaphragm spring, The hydraulic system comprises a master cylinder coupled to a slave cylinder which operates the clutch release ‘mechanism. Section E.1 CLUTCH ASSEMBLY The driven plate comprises a splined hub connected to a flexible ste] plate by a spring mounting. The annular friction facings are riveted to the plate and damper springs are assembled around the hub to absorb power shocks and torsional vibration. The diaphragm spring is interposed between two annular rings which provide fulcrum points for the diaphragm when it is flexed. The rings and the diaphragm are located and secured to the cover by nine equally spaced rivets. Three clips that engage the outer edge of the diaphragm are bolted to the pressure plate. The bolts pass through three straps which are riveted to the inside of the cover; the straps prevent the diaphragm and the pressure plate from rotating in relation to the cover. The release plate is secured directly to the diaphragm and is an integral part of the clutch cover assembly. On early cars the release plate is retained with a circlip and can be removed when the circlip is released. ‘The release bearing is graphite and is mounted in a cup which fits into the fork of the clutch withdrawal lever. The cup is held in position by two spring retainers. Removing Remove the engine as described in Section A.21. Loosen each of the bolts securing the clutch assembly to the flywheel by slackening them a turn at a time until spring pressure is released. The clutch cover can now be disengaged from the dowels on the flywheel and the assembly removed. Dismantling On earlier cars remove the circlip securing the release plate to the diaphragm and lift the plate from the diaphragm. Unscrew the three screws securing the clips to the pressure plate, a turn at a time, until the diaphragm contacts the cover. Remove the screws, clips, and washers and the pressure plate. Rotate the release bearing spring retainers through 90° and withdraw the bearing from the withdrawal lever fork, MGB. Isue4. 15676 Assembling Assembly is a reversal of the dismantling sequence, but ensure that the release bearing retainers are correctly located, Replacing Position the driven plate assembly on the flywheel with the large end of the hub away from the flywheel. Centralize the plate by using Service tool 18G 680, which fits the splined hub of the driven plate and the pivot bearing in the flywheel. As an alternative, a spare first motion shaft can be used, Locate the cover assembly on the flywheel dowels and secure it with the bolts; tighten the bolts down a tum at a time by diametrical selection. Do not remove the centralizer until all bolts are securely tightened, Remove the clutch centralizer and refit the engine. The weight of the gearbox must be supported during refitting in order to avoid strain on the first motion shaft and distortion or displacement of the release plate and straps, or driven plate assembly. Fig. E11 ‘A section through the clutch 1. Cover, 7, Release plate. 2. Strap bolt. 8. Strap release 3. Washer—tab. plate/cover, 4. Clip, 9. Diaphragm spring. 5. Strap-diaphragm cover. 10. Pressure plate. 6. Release bearing. 11, Driven plate E3 E THE CLUTCH Section E.2 SERVICING THE CLUTCH Driven plates It is important that neither oil nor grease should contact the clutch facings. It is essential to install a complete driven plate assembly when the renewal of the friction surfaces is required. If the facings have worn to such an extent as to warrant renewal, then slight wear will have taken place on the splines, and also on the torque reaction springs and their seatings. The question of balance and concentricity is also involved. Under no circumstances is it satisfactory to repair or rectify faults in clutch driven plate centres. Tolerances Wear on the working faces of the driven plate is about .001 in, (,02 mm.) per 1,000 miles (1600 km.) under normal running conditions. The accuracy of the alignment of the face of the driven plate must be within .O15 in. (.38 mm). Condition of clutch facings in service Itis natural to assume that a rough surface will give a higher frictional value against slipping than a polished one, but this is not necessarily correct. A roughened surface consists of small hills and dales, only the *highspots’ of which make contact, As the amount of useful friction for the purpose of taking up the drive is dependent upon the area in actual contact, it is obvious that a perfectly smooth face is required to transmit the maximum amount of power for a siven surface area. Since non-metallic facings of the moulded asbestos type hhave been introduced in service the polished surface is common, but it must not be confused with the glazed surface which is sometimes encountered due to conditions to be detailed subsequently. The ideally smooth or polished condition will therefore provide proper surface contact, but a glazed surface entirely alters the frictional value of the facing and will result in excessive clutch slip. These two conditions might be simply illustrated by comparison between a piece of smoothly finished wood and one with a varnished surface; in the former the contact is made directly by the original material, whereas in the latter instance a film of dry varnish is interposed between the contact surfaces and actual contact is made by the varnish. If the clutch has been in use for some time under satisfactory conditions, the surface of the facings assumes a high polish through which the grain of the material can be seen clearly. This polished facing is of light colour when in perfect condition. Should oil in small quantities gain access to the clutch and find its way onto the facings, it will be burnt off as a result of the heat generated by the slipping occurring under normal starting conditions. The buming of this small quantity of lubricant has the effect of gradually darkening the facings, but provided the polish of the facing remains Ba _ such that the grain of the material can be distinguished clearly, it has little effect on clutch performance. Should increased quantities of oil obtain access to the facing, then one of two conditions, or a combination of these, may arise, depending upon the nature of the oil. 1. The oil may burn off and leave a carbon deposit on the surface of the facings, which assume a high glaze, producing further slip. This is a very definite, though very thin, deposit, and in general it hides the grain of the material 2. The oil may partially burn and leave a resinous deposit on the facings. This has a tendency to produce a fierce clutch, and may also cause excessive ‘spinning’ due to the tendency of the face of the linings to adhere to the surface of the flywheel or pressure plate. There may be a combination of conditions 1 and 2 which produces a tendency to ‘judder’ on such engagement. Still greater quantities of oil produce a dark and soaked appearance of the facings, and the result will be further slip, accompanied by fierceness or ‘juddering’. If the conditions enumerated above are experienced, the clutch driven plate should be replaced by a new one. The cause of the presence of the oil must be traced and removed. It is, of course, necessary for the clutch and flywheel to be cleaned out thoroughly before assembly. Where the graphite release bearing ring is badly worn in service a complete replacement assembly should be fitted, returning the old assembly for salvage of the metal cup. These graphite rings are inserted into their metal cup by heating the metal cup to a cherry red, then forcing the graphite ring into position. Immediately the ring is forced into position the whole should be quenched in cil Alignment of the thrust pad in relation to its face and the trunnions should be within .005 in, (.12 mm.). In almost every case of rapid wear on the splines of the clutch driven plate misalignment is responsible. Looseness of the driven plate on the splined shaft results in noticeable backlash in the clutch. Misalignment also puts undue stress on the driven member, and may result in the hub breaking loose from the plate, with consequent total failure of the clutch, It may also be responsible for a fierce chattering or dragging of the clutch, which makes gear-changing difficult. In cases of persistent difficulty it is advisable to check the flywheel for truth with a dial indicator. The dial reading should not vary more than .003 in. (.07 mm,) anywhere on the flywheel face. Section E.3 MASTER CYLINDER The master cylinder has an integral-type supply tank in which the barrel passes through the tank. A piston contained within the barrel has a rubber main cup and is spring-loaded against its inner end; between the piston and cup is a thin washer which prevents the cup being drawn MGB, Issue 4. 15676 THE CLUTCH E into the feed holes drilled around the head of the piston, The outer end of the piston carries a secondary cup and is formed with a depression to receive the spherical end of the push-rod assembly. The push-rod has a piston stop that is retained in the body by a circlip. A rubber boot through which the push-rod passes is fitted to the end of the body. ‘At the opposite end of the barrel to the push-rod an end plug screws down against a gasket. This plug forms the outlet connection for the pipe line to the slave cylinder, Removing Remove the screws securing the brake and clutch master cylinder cover and take off the cover. Drain the fluid from the supply tank by attaching a rubber tube in the bleed screws in the clutch slave cylinder, opening the screw one full tum and then depressing the clutch pedal. Hold the pedal down and then tighten the serew and then let the pedal return unassisted. Repeat this operation until the tank is empty. Remove the split pin, washer, and clevis pin from the push-rod and disengage the clutch pedal lever. Clean the pipe connection, disconnect the pipe line, and fit a plug to the end of the cylinder to prevent the entry of dirt Unscrew the fixing bolts and detach the master cylinder from the box assembly Dimantling Detach the rubber boot from the barrel. Depress the piston to relieve the load on the circlip, then remove the circlip and the push-rod assembly. Withdraw the piston, piston washer, main cup, spring retainer, and spring. Remove the secondary cup by carefully stretching it over ‘the end of the piston. Examination Place all metal parts in a tray of clean Clutch and Brake Fluid to soak. Dry them with a clean, non-fluffy cloth. Rubber components are to be examined for swollen or perished cups or other signs of deterioration. Any suspect parts must be renewed, Swill the main castings in industrial methylated spirit and thoroughly dry out before assembly. Ensure that the by-pass ports are free of obstruction. The port is drilled with a # in, (3.17 mm.) drill for half its length and then finished with a .028 in, (.711 mm.) drill, Assembling Dip all components in Clutch and Brake Fluid and assemble when wet. Stretch the secondary cup over the piston with the lip of the cup facing the head of the piston. When the cup isin its groove work it round gently with the fingers to ensure that it is correctly seated. MGB. Issue3. 65891 Insert the return spring, largest diameter first, into the barrel and position the spring seat on the small-diameter end of the spring, Assemble the main cup, piston washer, piston, and push- rod, When assembling the cups carefully enter the lip edge of the cups into the barrel first. Depress the piston, position the piston stop, and retain it in the barrel with the circlip, Place the rubber boot in position and fit the dust excluder. Replacing Refit the master cylinder to the master cylinder box and secure it with the bolts. The long bolt passes through the stiffener plate. Remove the dust excluder and fit the pipe connection to the master cylinder, Refit the clutch pedal lever to the push-rod and secure it with the clevis pin, washer, and 2 new split pin. Refit the master cylinder cover. Fill the master cylinder and then prime and bleed the system, Section E.4 SLAVE CYLINDER ‘The slave cylinder incorporates two threaded connections for the feed hose and the-bleed screw and accommodates in the body a piston, a cup, and a spring. A rubber boot through which passes a push-rod is fitted to the body and is retained by two clips. The push-rod has an eyeend which connects with the clutch withdrawal fork. Removing Drain the system as described in Section E.3. Release the feed pipe from the cylinder and remove the two serews securing the cylinder to the clutch housing. The cylinder may be withdrawn, leaving the push-rod attached to the clutch withdrawal fork, or the rod may be detached from the fork. Dismantling Remove the rubber dust cover and with an air line blow out the piston and seal, Extract the spring and cup filler. Examine all components and renew any that are suspect. Assembling Place the spring in the cylinder, followed by the filler, cup, and piston. Depress the piston with the push-rod and refit the rubber boot. Secure the boot to the rod with the small clip and then fit the boot to the cylinder and secure it with the large circlip. BS vuru—dng “Lt IGM “OF “uonosuuoa ofeg 10} Nod “EE vuorsid—s04st “91 ‘yd 20y—ureHd—s0USeN “8 furg-wonaouvoy “Ze wong “st ” PuLAD—SA9P—U “Ly roypng 0} adi Ie Azepuooas-dny “pI 1q10}-funds NE“ ;peouping 01 aid vf sysnd—pow oqatad or opuKO- TOR “Se $09 0} a60U-134SED“6T 9 wsnd-pow “eh yooudayrus—s0usmAN “BZ Noon qa “ee soy 10} INUOT “LE dears “OL oom “te aIMII=280H “97 somy—de 6 (qe) 000-49“ 8041 01 1apundo Jayseut—adig “57 yur pur pura +g uota “oF 204] 0} s9pUys9 1aSPUL-adl “PE “wd 1o}-um|d aus OL ois day “6 smoios 20) NN “EZ pad 01 pus 3Ho}—sAap—wg “9 dno words “BE -wa19s s0}—funsds— reuse “ZT “yyouund yrpad-Bunds°s sony dno-aunds “Lg +x0q 01 auoys pur Z9puAD~N2H§ “1 ped ysinyo—20uestp—9ann of “9e N09 0} 19pUNIAD=MOHDS “0 ‘oaqans) wpad~ped“¢ mse) Se ‘tunds “61 sng 1ST] “PE dunds—roueamy “81 yoimpe-1eped “1 uonduosaq ON, wondzseq oN wondusseq oN, SININOdWOD TOWLNOD HOLD HL OL ATX eee a eres ee ET Issue 4, 15676 MGB. E THE CLUTCH Replacing Fit the cylinder to the clutch housing and secure it with the two screws. Assemble the push-rod to the clutch withdrawal fork. Connect the feed line and fill, prime, and bleed the system as described in Section E.5. Section E.5 BLEEDING THE CLUTCH SYSTEM Open the bleed screw on the slave cylinder three-quarters of a tum and attach a tube, immersing the open end in a clean receptacle containing a small quantity of the recommended hydraulic fluid. Fill the master eylinder reservoir with the recommended fluid (see “GENERAL DATA’). Using slow, full strokes, pump the clutch pedal until the fluid entering the container is completely free from air bubbles. On a down- stroke of the pedal tighten the bleed screw and remove the bleed tube. E8 Liga Fig. E.2 Bleeding the clutch hydraulic system at the slave cylinder MGB. Issue 4. 15676 SECTION F THE GEARBOX SECTION General description Lubrication Control tower—dismantling and assembling. ws oe BB Examination of components ee oo BS First motion shaft—dismantling and assembling... wee BS Fitting the gearbox front cover Fz Fitting replacement bushes eR Gearbox Assembling . ee . «Flo Dismantling e 3 a 5 4 ww FQ Removing Fl Laygear—dismantling and assembling Ln 6 Rear extension—dismantling and assembling. OB Third motion shaft Assembling. eS) Dismantling RT MGB. Issue 5, 25729 vesiey MGB. Issue 5. 28729 Ly Sov ve STE OF ee g \\ RA si ui—B Li Sn sy vy Ry & (sae snp wontms 30) sous, ste savy Hotins 1 28 -rondape slap iovetiopands Noa, nds “aun 09 F910. 9198 yonuos-dyoutas voqres 1910.) 2h09 0} 1918139 yoususord ron seat 1 ana) fe yoiou9 ‘ioqSutsdt— louse, "10q- 108 no of xo 10H mot oF xoaresd— $aijunout 0} xoqna3—Mor “anon oods ae un Pru nen or “you wows fy asus 3g Tee Netanya aH ‘vosustxe 0) 0} ~AOI9S “Samo JonU09 393s swoop satuntdostanos—fads rad a09003~ [0 -aafunyd otaia!—Suyieo0}—f “pone agi frei ds 198 os10891— a0 ofan antnotSetsgS -roiops sono! 9400 Sd 00 “Bud eq soa pond ate tide —ause)A satay poods aBuryp~dueoot” ud “you poods suey mood "io poo a8 QOu ponds sarl9—10107 “pmo) jortuossr0us mod Joxtuoosyotinl—amo, -xoqita8 ora, = 01821PT “voy pep 109-945 “FoAo] [eaesp IAEA IN| HO 2349] EMEIPIDEA WBN ‘Temespuptas yoanjo—a9007] wor dis0soq1 “a19s—J yuo] 1949] 10190)95- MOIS {WO3} 10199]95—1949"1 (uo -uarxa m1) jonuossiouros seus ‘838 lajawoponds a, “arauopeods— 1090) ‘yep wonow pay ~2oatd sours “paods ‘yuanoy pur pug —uypys—fujdno3, semuo;ypu sete Weq oatuomyouKs- Buds ‘paadstpano} ue pin -971woMS pap pur puooos—Surysoto ‘nod yeu ponte posta -Poods prooor— seo) 13 poods puoose_2utt Ae "i somuonouss unas ‘uosypUAS “Agu -eauongus pu oi pan soysem 1statp Bq -96'E) "UE SLST” TSN —295e yo onous pay —2eo1—snutp—foUse A, JO~101915}80% ‘uonow pm —1seuS 3838 2815001— Is astanat ApgUTDsse 1020) "89198 FALY90|10USP {J0GS a839431— M9195 “si98ad—-YeUs yeyscoy— suds sun “Suurwag s0984e|-20ueIsIP—aqn, ‘ayeysce|—Surzeaq 91p99u~29}10% “cum Legere 01 9st 1401 wordussaq ‘stl ‘Cum Z96°E 91 Z16°e) 9ST" 01 pst tar~ysmAup A5USEM, sPaBAP]-1U0s}— ISHN —194SEA “arusAey—qun 1095, “JEWSAE ay Aqquiasse wy “ysng nd 1n)auopaads~s04ysex 1UI0f “uoturd 21ewopaads urpo0 "yi0] as1aNai pe ‘por 310) poeds ‘gunoy pu pup —azard joordaqriy -duyyt00} u0}—9195 “poads uuanoy pur pry 420, “y20} paads puo2as put 1515- pod ‘unyb20] 310}—M2198~10N “9125 Joordsyeys—s0ISEM, “Bune30) 4201-m9:0$ -paads puosas pue sit} 3104, “Bunyeno] 310)—a910s—1NN ‘mou35—Jooud>eys— 04S 4 *Buny820] 330} dst9AaI—MOI0S 19401104 ynu—Aunsds—s04S64, Suey syeus wonow pnp rN 3yeus uoriow pay —o8ur] ‘uyvag 1801 01 1098 sayauopsads— fyquisse aoard sours Usb _yeys won our pary—2e9 wor dtosaqy SLNANOdNOO XOPAVID IHL OL ATI Sursnoy Fuse9q re01-Auneroy Hog “gy iuvaq 2e01—Bulsnol| “Zp jeys wonoW siya anu ‘yeys uonou ism5—Bupyo0I—s0UNe “OF "yeus uonow iSiy~aqpoau—iaON “BE ‘00-1 9 ue ‘uonow ism—1yeus “SE qquiosse somneaig PE maioe BUGS DYE “EE {woIsuaiXa 0} J0A09 apIs—MoII§ “Ze "uoIsuaIX9 01 s9n09 aps—saysem UIT “TE ‘uorsuayxa ar apIs—1010.) “OE Suyseo 0} UOIsuRIAd 1e91~pMIs—INN “6 ‘3198 BULGE 104 “BE te St ae oytaye ral ot “sown tae gi sojauiopaods—snutp wound Zz “uorsusixa rear—iade}—ind “TZ eo1-woIsuatxy “OC ‘mors yooulsyeB— IU “6l apys Noqueas—yunsiaqunos-m219§ “81 “mo1S-21QN—124SeM\ “LT -ByT A “IT sae “ST 19409 apis Xoquea3-M2ID$ “Fl uisea 01 19409 9pS—JOYSEM TWIT “EL ‘aps xoquead 1940.) “1 ‘pmis10N use) 6} 19409 yu01}-qnas—Bunds—r94se gst 0} J9A09 2U01}-J24SEN UOT aqua es ‘ywosj— Kiquasse 1a resp 3nd stuisea—qoqan—3ld, -yorsuayxa stat pris "9409 1UO1}- PMS sxoqirad 0 42019 SuNe90} [PROC Ayquuasse SUISe) uuon dts9s9¢1 F3 Issue 4. $335, MGB. F THE GEARBOX GENERAL DESCRIPTION ‘The gearbox has four forward gears and a reverse gear: Top, third, and second gear engagement are effected by synchromesh hubs with direct drive for top gear and constant-mesh gears on the layshaft and mainshaft for third and second gears. First and reverse gears are sliding spur gears. A combined dipstick and filler plug is housed in the top of the gearbox and a drain plug in the bottom. The bell housing is integral with the gearbox and accommodates the clutch release mechanism and the starter motor driving pinion, ‘An extension bolted to the rear end of the gearbox contains the gear selector mechanism. The gearbox is bolted at the front end to the engine mounting plate and is supported at the rear by two rubber mountings that locate on the rear cross-member mounting brackets. An engine stay-rod attached to the under side of the rear extension is anchored to the rear cross-member. LUBRICATION Oil level When topping up the gearbox ensure that it is not filled above the “HIGH” mark on the dipstick. If the level is too high, oil may get into the clutch case and cause clutch slip. ‘The combined filler plug and dipstick for the gearbox and overdrive is located beneath the rubber plug on the gearbox cover. Draining Remove the gearbox drain plug and drain off the oil When the gearbox has been drained, completely refill with fresh oil Section F.1 REMOVING THE GEARBOX Prepare the engine for removal from the car as detailed in Section A and take the weight of the engine. 2. Drain the oil from the gearbox. 3. Disconnect and remove the propeller shaft as detailed in Section G and disconnect the speedometer pinion drive, 4. Disconnect the clutch slave cylinder push-rod from the clutch withdrawal lever and the slave cylinder from the clutch housing. Tie the cylinder clear of the gearbox. 5. Remove the screws securing the rear cross-member to the body and lower the engine and gearbox until the gearbox rests on the fixed body cross-member. 6. .Release the engine stay-tod bracket from the rear cross-member and remove tne four nuts and washers securing the gearbox rear rubber mountings to the cross-member. Withdraw the rear cross-member from the body. Fa 7, Remove the gear lever knob and the rubber cover from the tunnel. Remove the remote-control tower complete with gear lever from the gearbox. 8, Ease the assembly forward until itis clear of the fixed body cross-member and then tilt the assembly and lift it from the car. 9. Remove the screws securing the gearbox to the engine rear mounting plate and separate the gearbox from the engine. NOTE.—Great care must be taken during this operation to ensure that no load is placed on the clutch release plate drive straps. Even slight damage to these may result in the clutch breaking up at high speeds. 10. Remove the stiffnut and washer from the clutch withdrawal lever bolt and take the dust cover and lever from the clutch housing, 11, Remove the nut, spring washer, and pin from the engine stay-rod and the stay-rod from the gearbox. 12, If the stay-rod and bracket are to be dismantled remove the rear nut and washer and slide off the plates, buffers, brackets, and distance tube. Separate the plates, buffers, and brackets from the distance tube. Section F.2 DISMANTLING THE GEARBOX 1, Remove the dipstick, drain plug, and speedometer drive pinion. 2. Using Service toot 18G 2, remove the propeller shaft flange. 3. Remove the remote-control tower, the gearbox extension side cover, and the interlock plate and bracket. 4. Slacken the locating screw on the remote-control front selector lever, unscrew the screws and nuts securing the extension to the gearbox, and remove the extension 5. Retain the remote-control selector lever, which will fall free as the extension is withdrawn, Withdraw the shaft and rear selector lever from the rear extension and remove the selector lever from the shaft; withdraw the split bush and circlip from the selector. 6. Remove the three countersunk screws and seven hexagon-headed screws from the gearbox side cover and lift off the cover and gasket. 7. Cut the locking wire, unscrew the three selector locating screws, and remove the selectors. 8. Unscrew the shift shaft locating block screws and remove the block from the rear face of the gearbox. Retain the three balls and springs which will be released when the block is withdrawn from the shafts. Two dowels on the block locate it on the rear face of the gearbox. 9. Release the locknuts and remove the fork locating screws and star washers from the change speed forks. MGB. Issued. 5335 THE GEARBOX F Slide out the shafts and remove the forks in the following order: reverse, fourth and third speed, second and first speed. 10. If difficulty is experienced in removing the shafts remove the front cover and use a soft drift to tap the shafts out from the front of the box. 11. Remove the nuts and washers securing the front cover and then remove the cover, gasket, and the first ‘motion shaft bearing shims, Do not remove the oil seal from the cover unless it has to be renewed. 12. Unscrew the reverse shaft locating screw and remove the shaft and gear. 13, Using a soft drift, tap out the layshaft from the front of the box and allow the laygear to rest in the bottom of the box. 14, Ease the rear bearing housing from the rear of the gearbox and withdraw the third motion shaft assembly. 15. Withdraw the first motion shaft from the front of the gearbox. A soft drift may be used to tap the shaft from the inside of the box. 16. Reassemble the laygear on its shaft and check the end-float of the gear (see “GENERAL DATA") 17, Remove the layshatt, laygear, and thrust washers. Section F.3 DISMANTLING AND ASSEMBLING THE CONTROL TOWER Do not dismantle the control tower unless worn or broken parts are to be renewed, 1, Remove the ball spring cover circlip to ease the tension on the spring and then remove the two change speed lever locating pins, Withdraw the lever, and from, it, remove the knob, cover and spring. ann ni ) ! ASW, Fig Fl (Checking the laygear end-float MGB. Issue 4. 5335 assaaw Fig. F2 Using Service tool 18G 5 to unscrew a first motion shaft nut, This nut has. left-hand thread 2. From the rear of the control tower unscrew the reverse plunger detent screw and remove the reverse plunger detent spring and ball 3. Frovn the side of the tower remove the reverse plunger locating pin and retain the plunger and spring that will be released from inside the tower. Assembly is @ reversal of the dismantling sequence, but care must be taken to ensure that the front and rear selectors are correctly lined up and that the clinch bolts pass across the flats on the remote-control shaft. When fitting a new pin to retain the reverse selector plunger ensure that the plunger is depressed sufficiently enough to permit the pin to engage the flats on the plunger. Section F.4 DISMANTLING AND ASSEMBLING THE REAR EXTENSION 1. Remove the rear selector lever clamp bolt, lever, and the Woodruff key and withdraw the shaft from the rear extension. Do not dismantle the rear extension any further unless the oil seal and/or bearing has to be renewed, in which case proceed as follows. 2. Using Service tool 18G 389 and 18G 389 C, remove the rear oil seal 3. Remove the rear extension bearing circlip and press out the bearing. Assembly is a reversal of the dismantling sequence. If the bearing and/or oil seal have/has been removed, press in the new bearing and secure it with the circlip, and, using Service tool 18G 134 and adaptor 18G 134 N, fit the new oil seal FS THE GEARBOX Fig F3 Laygear assembly second type 1. Thrust washer~small 2. Needle-roller bearing (pais) 3. Distance tube 4, Laygear. S._Layshatt 6, Thrust washer-large Section F.5 DISMANTLING AND ASSEMBLING THE FIRST MOTION SHAFT 1. Remove the spindle rollers from the spigot bearing housing. 2. Secure the shaft in a soft-jawed vice, release the lock washer, and, using Service tool 18G 5, unscrew the locknut, NOTE.—The locknut has a left-hand thread, 3, Press the bearing from the shaft and remove the spring ring from the bearing. Assembly is a reversal of the dismantling sequence. Section F.6 DISMANTLING AND ASSEMBLING. THE LAYGEAR FIRST TYPE Remove the circlips from the ends of the laygear and withdraw the needle-roller bearing assemblies and the distance tube. To assemble the laygear proceed as follows: 1. Hold the layshaft in a vice, stepped end downwards. 2. Smear the shaft with grease and assemble a bearing assembly, the distance tube, and the remaining two bearing assemblies to the shaft 3. Fit a circlip to the front end of the laygear and place the laygear on the shaft, 4. Remove the laygear and shaft from the vice, fit the remaining circlip, and remove the shaft from the gear. ‘SECOND TYPE, ‘The second-type laygear has a larger diameter shaft and a pair of caged needle-roller bearings at each end. Extract the two paits of needle-roller bearings from the ends of the laygear and the distance tube from the small end. To assemble the laygear proceed as follows: 1. Dip the bearings in oil. 2. Hold the laygear in a vice and insert the distance tube and a pair of bearings at the small end. 3. Insert a pair of bearings at the large end. F6 Section F.7 DISMANTLING THE THIRD MOTION SHAFT Before dismantling the third motion shaft check the end-float on the third speed mainshaft gear to ensure the fitting of the correct thrust washer during reassembly of the third motion shaft 1. Remove the third and fourth speed gear front baulk ring, the synchromesh sleeve and hub, and the rear baulk ring. The synchromesh sleeve may be withdrawn from the hub, but care must be taken to retain the balls and springs that will be released when the sleeve is withdrawn from the hub. 2. Depress the front thrust washer retaining peg, rotate the washer to align its splines with those on the shaft, and remove the washer. 3. Withdraw the third speed gear and its bush and then remove the bush interlock ring to free the second speed gear. Remove the gear, baulk ring, bush, and thrust washer. 4. Withdraw the first and second speed synchromesh and gear. The first gear may be disengaged from the hub, but care must be taken to retain the balls and springs, that will be released when the gear is withdrawn from the hub, 5. Remove the speedometer drive gear and its Woodruff key and then slide the distance piece from the shaft. 6. Press the bearing from the shaft and then from its housing. Section F.8 EXAMINATION OF COMPONENTS Thoroughly clean, dry, and examine all components for wear, distortion, deterioration, and thread damage, paying particular attention to the following: 1. Bushes fitted to the clutch withdrawal fork, third motién shaft, and reverse speed gear. Worn ot damaged bushes should be renewed (Section F.1 1) Fig. 4 Checking the mainshaft second and third speed gear end-float MGB. Issue 4, $335 THE GEARBOX I 2. Bearings fitted to the first motion shaft, third motion shaft, and rear extension. Examine the bearings for looseness, pitting, security fof cages, and fit in their housings and on their journals Examine also the needle rollers in the first motion shaft and the laygear. Unserviceable bearings should be renewed. 3. Spring fitted to the synchromesh hubs, shaft locating block, reverse shaft, and reverse plunger detent. Comparisons may be made with new springs, but where facilities for test are available refer to the weights and lengths given under ‘GENERAL DATA’ 4, The rubber gaiters for the clutch withdrawal fork and gear lever for cracks or signs of deterioration. 5. Ensure that all oilways are clear of obstruction, including the oil restrictor in the front of the third motion shaft, 6. Examine the interlock arm for burrs and for security of the rivet. Section F.9 ASSEMBLING THE THIRD MOTION SHAFT Lubricate all contact surfaces with oil, and smear the bore of the gears with Duckham’s Moly Disulphide Grease (max. size $ microns), 1. Use Service tools 18G 222 and 18G 223 to assemble the second speed synchromesh hub and third and top gear synchromesh hub respectively. 2. Press the rear bearing into its housing and the bearing onto the shaft, apie Fig. FS Securing the mainshatt gears C. Locating pes. D. Locking washer 'B, Peg located in the washer. MGB. Isue4, 1329 A. Hole for spring B. Spring Fig. F.6 ‘Assembling a synchromesh hub, using Service tool 18G 222 3. Fit the speedometer gear drive to the shaft with its key. 4, Fit the first gear and second gear synchromesh to the shaft, followed by the baulk ring and rear thrust washer. 5. Fit the second speed gear bush to the shaft and ensure that the lugs face forward and that the oil hole in the bush is in alignment with the oil hole in the shaft. 6. Assemble the second speed gear and the interlock washer so that the washer engages the lugs on the bush, 7. Fit the third speed gear bush, lugs first, and ensure that the lugs engage the interlock washer and that the oil hole and cut-away in the bush are in alignment with the holes in the shaft 8. Place the retaining pin spring and pin in the shaft and the third speed gear on the bush with the cone facing forward. 9. Position the gear so that the hole in the cone is in line with the retaining peg, depress the peg with a thin drift, fit the thrust washer to the shaft, then tum the washer to allow the peg to lock the washer in position. Check the end-float of the second and third speed gear (see ENERAL DATA’ and Fig. F.4). Thrust washers are available in four thicknesses as follows: £1565 to .1575 in, (3.96 to 3.98 mm.) 1585 to .1595 in, (4.01 to 4.03 mm.) -1605 to .1615 in, (4.06 to 4.08 mm.) 10. Assemble the third and fourth speed gear rear bavlk ring, synchromesh, and front baulk ring. Section F.10 ASSEMBLING THE GEARBOX Any gaskets or locking devices that are unserviceable or suspect should be renewed during assembly of the gearbox. 1. Place the laygear in the bottom of the gearbox together with the thrust washers (see Section F.2, paragraph 16)and thread a piece of stiff wire through the laygear to allow Service tool 18G 471 to FT THE GEARBOX ey 10, ML. 12, FS Fig. F7 Assembling a selector shaft, using Service tool 18G 4 pick up the thrust washers and laygear. The washers are available in four thicknesses as follows: -154 to .156 in. (3.81 to 3.96 mm,). -157 to .159 in, (3.95 to 4.03 mm). -160 to .161 in. (4.06 to 4.08 mm.). 163 to .164 in, (4.13 to 4.16 mm). Fit the first motion shaft assembly to the gearbox. Insert the third motion shaft from the rear of the box, use the gearbox extension gasket to align the dowel in the bearing housing, enter the spigot in the first motion shaft, and push home the shaft and bearing housing. Using Service tool 18G 471, fit the layshaft to the laygear and ensure that the cut-away end of the shaft faces forward. Assemble the reverse gear and shaft and secure the shaft with the locating screw and a new tab washer. Lock the screw with the washer, Refit the first motion shaft bearing shims, align the step on the end of the layshaft with the inside edge of the front cover, and, using Service tool 18G 598, fit the front cover as described in Section F.12. ‘Assemble the clutch withdrawal lever with its bolt and stiffnut. Bolt the shaft locating block to the rear face of the gearbox and insert the three springs and balls into the block. Assemble the selectors to the shafts and secure them with their locating screws. Lock the screw heads to the selectors with new locking wire. Using Service tool 18G 41, depress the springs and balls in the locating block and pass the shafts through the block. Position the gear change forks in the box in the following order: reverse, first and second speed, third and fourth speed. Fit the distance piece to the third and fourth speed shaft, push the shafts through the forks, align the holes in the shafts and forks, and secure them with the fork locating screws. Tighten the locknut on each 13. Replace the gearbox side cover and gasket. 14, Place the third motion shaft distance piece on the shaft and the extension gasket over the studs on the rear face of the gearbox. 15, Fit the rear extension to the gearbox and engage the ear extension remote-control shaft in the front selector and the dowel on the third motion shaft bearing housing with the hole in the extension, 16. Secure the selector with its Woodruff key and pinch-bolt and replace the extension side cover and gasket. 17. Refit the speedometer drive pinion, drain plug, dipstick, and rear joint flange 18. After refitting the gearbox to the vehicle replace the control tower and its gasket and fill the box with clean oil, Section F.i1 FITTING REPLACEMENT BUSHES When fitting replacement bushes to the reverse gear, the clutch withdrawal fork, and the third motion shaft remove the old bushes and fit the new ones as follows. Reverse gear Press the new bush into the gear from the small end of the gear until the end of the bush is flush with the face of the small end. Finish to an internal diameter of between .6255 and .6265 in, (15.8 and 15.9 mm.) concentric with the gear teeth. Clutch withdrawal fork Press in the new bush and finish to an inside diameter of between .4996 and .5004 in. (12.6 and 12.7 mm,). Fig. FB Using tool 18G 471 as a pilot when installing the layshaft 1. Pilot. 2. Layshaft MGB. Issue4, 1329 THE GEARBOX F Third motion shaft bushes Heat the bushes to between 180 and 200°C. (356 and 392° F.), ensure that the locating tongues on the bushes are in line with the splines on the shaft and that the oil holes are in line, then assemble the second-speed bush, interlock washer, and third speed bush. Section F.12 FITTING THE GEARBOX FRONT COVER To prevent oil leaking past the gearbox front cover oil seal the cover must be correctly fitted to ensure that the seal is concentric with the first motion shaft. When refitting the cover proceed as follows. Clean off the cover and examine it carefully for burrs and bruising, particularly around the bore, stud holes, and machined surfaces. Check the flat surfaces for twist and warp, and correct it if necessary. If the condition is too bad to correct, fit a new cover. Remove and discard the front cover to gearbox gasket and clean off the flat surfaces around the base of all studs. Offer the front cover (less oil seal) to the gearbox and push it fully home on the studs. The cover should be free to ‘move in all directions, and points at which the holes may be binding on the studs must be relieved until the cover is free to ‘float’, Remove the cover and, using Service tool 18G 134 with adaptor 18G 134 N, fit the oil seal so that its lip faces Tet ' As087W Fig. F9 Removing a rear oil seal, using Service tools 18G 389 and 18G 389 B MGB. Issue 4. 15676 Fig. F:10. Installing a mew rear oil seal, using Service tools 18G 134 and 18G 134 N inwards towards the gearbox. Lightly grease and fit a new gasket to the gearbox front face, then fit the centralizer (Service tool 18G 598) to the bore of the front cover and push it in until it is tight. Lightly oil the seal and pass the cover over the first motion shaft, taking particular care not to cut or damage the knife edge of the seal Keep the centralizer firmly in position, push the cover onto the studs, and fit the spring washers and nuts, tightening the nuts finger tight only. Use a suitable socket spanner and Jong extension to tighten the nuts a half-turn at a time by diametrical selection until all nuts are fully tightened. Remove the centralizer and refit the clutch-operating components. F9 Fa SECTION Fa THE OVERDRIVE (TYPE ‘D’) SECTION Construction ; oe Fa Description. = Se Fad Dismantling and reassembling the unit - . Fal Drive shaft bearings and seal. Fall Guide to service diagnosis Fad Hydraulic lever setting... a Ln oe . Fa? Lubrication - Fal Operating valve - Fas Overdrive relay system ee Fad Pumpnonsetumvalve.. ew ee Relief valve. . - FRE Removing and replacing the unit. re Fad MGB. Issue 4. 22802 Fal THE OVERDRIVE COMPONENTS uty ION 2Buv])—J0US6 Suydnos— 380014 “ayes yaras~8U11 0, 7 Ba J191-$POG ‘apa jaraa—sa8tunig “aa Joyor—Suuds ‘nid 10) 2043044 ates Jaujas—Bnid Joys uonow puny —Bu deus “y0us us — UH U7eus won OU pan A034 Sur1eaq sayowopaods—[eas 10, ‘998 uanup 1a1910po9dS “Apquiosse Buuzeaq aanp saiowopeeds 39198 Bu90] 10) 94S6 ‘Suyswaq sarowop2ods— 9498 $4400] Wd Sut O, 1048 vorrow pa—Usng APEDIS 1938 10 a ayseas SmI, “ysng 808 Sujap so1owopaads ‘sauur—funrag “sojlozarpoau—Bunseaq, *aquuasse srynuuy ‘Buyreaq sna, “aMNON 110 ‘uu deus, ‘yon 103 Sunzdg “ypinp jeuonsamp-yuN—r9]}0Y wondusaq cor zo 101 ‘oot 66 36 6 96 s6 6 £6 %6 06 68 88 18 98 58 «8 ze 18 08 6L 8L u ‘OL SL bL el TL u “on oN, yeinp uonsesrpqun—a8e) “69 ‘woinyp jeuonsanpyun—soquiow uu] “ag -yyeys wonow pang Buu un%907 “19 “auie UB “99 “Aquasse eoun ung sg aN +59 sraysen yo “69 cooid apd “29 3.0, 119 “1ag09 oH} 0} 010F “09 aurea: poy uns-fun deus “65 Sunmeioe Sueaq—dipay “as -uimas wmp—Buuds “96 Supsnoy Sutse9q 10) 108 “Ss ciouieies—oreid “6S asum—fuuee “es -ausnoy fuueag “76 “arquasse wat “1s “Boyd 10} s04SEH—“OS ‘ona wimazuou—inig “6p ajea unyaruou-Buuds “gy -£p0q dumnd Bunw20] MOBS “Ly eas “9F Apoq anita wiN}aUON “Sp Suds saBunyd dung “py “spoq dung “ty Wd “tb sredunyd dmg “Ty “And 1} 2useH “OF 19404q ploUs}os 10) qd “6E srayses jooudayrus “$e “prouatos 10} now9S “Lg plousjos so} or “9 yRUBUPOHIPS “SE uondi96eq oN SLNANOdWOD FALNGUIAO FHL OL ATH ‘pouayes “o4sti oodoyeys "MO1o8 195, ‘rmyd-san09 10) HO “plousjos—19409, -u11,0, “ud “urd -Aquuasse sana] aaqea Bunye20d) ‘anea Su€300Q Tea Toms -aajea Sunerodo—1o8unig ‘aqna Suresado- funds ‘ind 405 soup “oajea Bunetado 105 Sai “Boyd 205 soyeM ‘and uyea -raysea joordoyeys, "ma108 19, “aynyd-sonoa 105 1u}0f ‘aimd-s9a09 apis, su onousey ‘ed Buyz0g, mL AN, saysem Sunsds Suyseo ayerpauusnay aun oer, soydepe xoqueaS 0} Surseo wteur—pmis, -roxdepe xoqiead 0 Suiseo urew— pris “Busse war 0} Bunse9 uteur—pris “futses 12910} Buyse9 uteur—pmis ‘Aiquiasse Butseo UIEWY ‘uoystd Suez0dQ uondioseq “ve €€ te Te ‘OE ca 8z We “ot St € wa 1% oz 61 81 u 31 SI wr el a 1 ‘ol 54980 Issue 2 MGB. Fa THE OVERDRIVE Section Fa.1 LUBRICATION ‘The overdrive shares a common oil supply with the gearbox; it is filled and topped up through the gearbox dipstick hole and the oil level is checked with the gearbox dipstick. Draining When an overdrive is fitted, remove the overdrive drain plug marked ‘DRAIN’ and the gearbox drain plug, and drain off the old oil Remove the overdrive filter cover-plate and gasket from the leftthand side of the unit and withdraw the filter gauze, together with the filter seal and magnetic rings. Wash the gauze in fuel and clean out the filter housing. Clean the filter seal and remove all deposits from the magnetic rings Replace the filter seal (metal surface inwards) and place the ‘magnetic rings in the filter location. Refit the filter, gasket, and cover-plate, replace the drain plugs, and refill with fresh oil. Check the filter cover-plate and drain plug for leaks. Section Fa2 DESCRIPTION The overdrive unit comprises a hydraulically controlled epicyclic gear housed in a casing which is directly attached to an extension at the rear of the gearbox. The gearbox third motion shaft is extended and carries at its end the inner member of a uni-directional clutch. The ‘outer ring of the clutch is carried in the combined annulus, and output shaft. ‘Also mounted on the third motion shaft are the planet carrier and a freely rotatable sun wheel, and sliding thereon is a cone clutch member the inner lining of which engages the outside of the annulus while the outer lining engages a cast-iron brake ring sandwiched between the main and tail casings. The cone clutch is held in contact with the annulus by compression springs, thus locking the sun wheel to the annulus so that the entire gear train rotates as a solid unit, a a NN os giving direct drive. In this condition the drive is taken through the uni-directional clutch. Reverse torque ot overrun is taken by the planet wheels, which being locked by the sun wheel, transmit the drive via the planet carrier and third motion shaft. Hydraulic pressure produced when overdrive is selected forces two pistons in the unit housing against the cone clutch and overcomes the spring pressure, causing the cone clutch to engage with the stationary brake ring and bring the sun wheel to rest, allowing the annulus to overrun the uni-directional clutch and give an increased speed to the output shaft, i. ‘overdrive’, When changing from overdrive to direct gear, if the accelerator pedal is released the vacuum switch holds ‘overdrive’ until the engine takes up the drive. If the accelerator pedal is not released, when contact between the cone clutch and brake is broken, the unit still operates momentarily in its overdrive ratio as engine speed and road speed remain unchanged. When the load on the engine is released it begins to accelerate, speeding up the sun wheel from rest until, just at the instant when its speed synchronizes with the speed of the annulus, the whole unit revolves solidly and the uni-directional clutch takes up the drive once more. The movement of the cone clutch is deliberately slowed down so that the uni-directional clutch is driving before the cone clutch contacts, ensuring a perfectly synchronized change. Section Fa3 CONSTRUCTION The third motion shaft of the gearbox is extended to camry first a cam operating the oil pump and then a steady bearing with a plain’ phosphor-bronze bush carried in the main housing, Next is the sun wheel of the epicyclic gear carried on a Clevite bush, and behind this the shaft is splined to take the planet carrier and uni-directional clutch. The end of the shaft is reduced and is carried in a needle-roller bearing in the output shaft. The latter is supported in the rear housing by two roller bearings. The clutch member slides on the splines of the sun wheel — = i T 43 3 i Fig. Fat Dizect drive 1. Spring pressure. 4, Cone cluteh, 2, Third motion shaft 5. Unidirectional cluteh, 3. Sun wheel, Fad Fig. Fa.2 Overdrive engaged 1, Hydraulic pressure 2 Brake ring, 3. Planet wheel, 4, Planet carrer, 5. Annulus. MGB. Issue 1. 65891 THE OVERDRIVE Fa extension to contact either the annulus or the cast-iron braking ring forming part of the unit housing, AA ball bearing housed in a flanged ring is secured to the cone clutch member. This carries four bolts which act as guides to compression springs by which the ring, and with it the clutch member, is held against the annulus. The action of the springs prevent free-wheeling on overrun and they are of sufficient strength to handle reverse torque. Also secured to the four bolts are two bridge pieces against which bear two pistons operating in cylinders formed in the unit housing. The cylinders are connected by ports in the hydraulic system to a relief valve which regulates the pressure developed by the oil pump, When the valve is open (overdrive selected), oil under pressure is admitted to the cylinders and pushes the pistons forward to engage the overdrive clutch, Closing the valve cuts off the supply of oil to the cylinders and allows it to escape. Under the influence of the springs the clutch member moves back to engage direct drive position. The escape of oil from the cylinders is deliberately restricted so that the clutch takes up slowly. The sun wheel and pinions are case-hardened and the annulus heat-treated. Gear teeth are helical. The pinions have needle-roller bearings and run on case-hardened pins. The outer ring of the uni-directional clutch is pressed into the annulus member. The clutch itself is of the caged roller type, loaded by a lock-type spring made of round wire. The hydraulic system is supplied with oil by a plunger-type pump operated by a cam on the gearbox third motion shaft. The pump body is pressed into the main housing and is located by a grub screw. The pump delivers oil through a non-return valve to a relief valve, in which a piston moves back against a compression spring until the required pressure is reached, at this point a hole in the relief valve is uncovered. The spill oil from the relief valve is led through Fig. Fa3 Hydraulic system—direct drive 1. Operating cylinders. 4. Jet. 2. Cam. S. Operating linkage 3. Operating valve. MGB. Issue 4, 65891 drilled passages to an annular groove in the steady bush on the third motion shaft. Radial holes in the shaft collect oil and deliver it through an axial drilling to other radial holes in the shaft from which it is fed to the needle-roller bearing, thrust washer, and uni-directional clutch, and is led to the planet gear pins by a thrower attached to the planet cartier. When ‘Overdrive’ is selected the valve is lifted, thus holding the ball off its seat against the spring pressure of the plunger spring. Oil passes to the operating cylinders, forcing the pistons forward to engage the overdrive cluteh. With the selection of ‘Normal’ drive the spring plunger pushes the ball onto its seat and the valve falls away from the ball. Oil from the cylinders then returns through the centre of the valve to the sump. Near the bottom of the valve is a small jet which slows down the emptying of the cylinders, to provide smooth re-engagement of direct drive. For direct drive the oil is returned to the sump via the ‘operating valve and flows in open circuit (Fig. Fa.3). Section Fa.4 GUIDE TO SERVICE DIAGNOSIS Overdrive does not engage J. Insufficient oil in the unit 2. Solenoid not operating due to fault in electrical system, 3. Solenoid operating lever out of adjustment. 4. Insufficient hydraulic pressure due to pump non-return valve incorrectly seating (probably dirt on ball seat), Fig. Fad Hydraulic system-overdrive 1. Oi pump. 5S. Axial drilling third motion 2. Oil inte. shaft 3. Non-return valve. 6. Third motion shaft steady 4. Oil relief valve. bush. Fas i 6 | 81 “4 31 $1 +t jumesado “pote o umoys se Joao aun pur an 29aNp FuINoN tup2080 SM TO assie a “SI a a a 5 LI ’ z ? € OAS EE Z zz ys : > y ay a " of 6 Uys ot 9 MGB. Ise 2. 54980 Fa6 THE OVERDRIVE Fa 5. Insufficient hydraulic pressure due to sticking or worn relief valve, 6. Damaged gears, bearings, or moving parts within the Unit requiring removal and inspection of the assembly. Overdrive does not release (NOTE.—Do not attempt to reverse the car or damage may bbe caused within the overdrive unit.) Fault in electrical control system. Blocked restrictor jet in operating valve. Solenoid operating lever adjustment. Sticking clutch. Damaged parts within the unit necessitating removal and inspection of the assembly. yaepe Clutch slip in overdrive As 1,3, 4, and 5 under ‘Overdrive does not engage’. Clutch slip in reverse or free-wheel condition on overrun 1. Solenoid operating lever out of adjustment. 2. Partially blocked restrictor jet in operating valve. 3. Worn clutch linings, Section Fa.S PUMP NON-RETURN VALVE Access to the pump non-return valve is gained through the centre cap in the bottom of the main casing (see [2], Fig. Fa6). Removing 1, Remove the engine stay rod fom the gearbox adaptor and the stay rod bracket from the rear cross-¢member. 2. Remove the drain plugs and drain off the oil 3. Unclip the locking wire. Unscrew the valve cap and take out the spring and ball and unscrew the non-return valve body from the pump body. Clean the components and examine the seating for pits, ete. If the ball valve is not seating correctly the ball should be tapped sharply onto its seat in the non-return valve body, using a soft-metal drift Fig. Fa6 Bottom view of overdrive unit 1. Drain plug 2. Non-return valve plug. 60230 3. Relief valve plug. MGB. Issue 3. Reassembly is the reverse of the above sequence. Position the ball on the spring with petroleum jelly. Ensure that the copper washer between the valve cap and main casing is fitted correctly over the step on the cap. NOTE.- The valve body must be removed from the pump body to reseat the ball valve, otherwise damage may be caused to the pump. RELIEF VALVE Access to the relief valve is gained through the right-hand cap in the bottom of the main casing (see [3], Fig. Fa.6). Removing 1. Remove the engine stay rod from the gearbox adaptor and the stay rod bracket from the rear cross-member. 2. Remove the drain plugs and drain off the oi 3. Unclip the locking wire. Unscrew the valve cap and remove the spring and piston. 4. Remove the relief valve body with circlip pliers, taking care not to damage the piston bore. Reassembly is the reverse of the above sequence. Ensure that the copper washer between the cap and main casing is fitted correctly over the step on the cap. Section Fa.7 HYDRAULIC LEVER SETTING The setting of the operating lever can be checked by means of a hole in the lever accessible from under the car after removal of the cover-plate on the right-hand side of the unit. The controls are set correctly when a i in. (4.76 mm.) diameter rod can be passed through the hole in the lever into the hole in the casing with the solenoid energized, ic with the ignition switched on, top gear engaged, and the fascia switch in the ‘Overdrive’ position. If the solenoid operates but does not move the setting lever far enough to allow the rod to be inserted, the solenoid plunger must be adjusted as follows. Screw the selflocking nut on the plunger in or out, with the plunger pushed into the solenoid as far as it will go. The plunger must be held against rotation with a spanner on ‘two flats on the spindle. The operating lever fork should just contact the nut with the & in, (4.74 mm.) rod in position, Operate the overdrive several times and check that the setting rod can be inserted and that the solenoid current does not exceed 2 amperes. If the current is maintained at 17 amperes (approx.), it indicates that the solenoid plunger is not moving far enough to switch from the operating to the holding coil; the plunger must therefore be readjusted. Fa7 Fa THE OVERDRIVE wa mh i" ANNAN 49293 Fig. Fa7 ‘Align the operating lever to check the adjustment of the ‘operating plunger ‘A new plunger must be fitted with a new solenoid. It will be necessary to check the setting for correct valve operation after fitment. Section Fa8 OPERATING VALVE ‘Access may be gained to the operating valve after removing, the gear selector remote control assembly from inside the car (see Section Fa.9). Having gained access, unscrew the plug and remove the spring and plunger. The ball valve will then be seen inside the valve chamber. The ball should be lifted ss in. (.8 mm.) off its seat when the solenoid is operated. If the ball does not lift, the fault lies in the control mechanism (see Section Fa.7). Remove the ball with a magnet and pull out the valve, using a piece of 4 in. (3.175 mm, dia. wire, taking care not to damage the seating at the top of the valve. Near the bottom of the valve will be seen a small hole breaking through the centre drilling; this is the jet for restricting the exhaust of cil from the operating cylinders. Check the bore of the operating valve with a} in, (3.175 mm.) diameter drill and blow out the jet, If the ball valve is not seated correctly the ball should be tapped sharply onto its seat in the casing, using a soft-metal drift. If the unit fails to operate and the ball valve is seating and lifting correctly check that the pump is functioning, as follows. Jack up the rear wheels, then with the engine idling and the valve plug removed engage top gear. Watch for oil being pumped into the valve chamber. If none appears, then the pump is not functioning, Possible causes of trouble are: (1) Failure of the non-return valve due to foreign matter on the seat or to a broken valve spring, and (2) Breakage of the spring holding the pump plunger in contact with the cam. Fag Testing oil pressure Remove the operating valve plug, fit an adaptor (Service tool 18G 251D) in its place, and connect up a pressure gauge. Jack up the rear wheels and then with the engine idling engage top gear. Operate the overdrive solenoid; a pressure of 540 to 560 Ib./sq, in. (37.97 to 39.37 keer?) should be recorded, Section Fa.9 REMOVING AND REPLACING To dismantle the unit further than already described necessitates the removal of the unit from the car. It is not possible to lift out the overdrive alone from the car; the engine, gearbox, and overdrive must be removed complete. Removing 1. Prepare the engine for removal from the car as detailed in Section A, and take the weight of the engine Remove the retainer and pull the gear lever grommet clear of the remote control cover. Release the circlip and withdraw the gear lever from its housing, 3. Withdraw the four screws securing the speaker panel and remove the panel. Pull back the tunnel carpet and remove the gearbox remote control cover. 4, Pull the solenoid wire from the snap connector and disconnect the gear switch wires. 5. Drain the oil from the gearbox and overdrive. 6. Disconnect and remove the propeller shaft as detailed in Section G, and disconnect the speedometer pinion dive. 7. Disconnect the clutch slave cylinder push-tod from the clutch withdrawal lever and the slave cylinder from the clutch housing. Tie the cylinder clear of the gearbox. 8. Remove the screws securing the rear cross-member to the body and lower the engine and gearbox until the gearbox rests on the fixed body cross-member. 9. Release the engine stay-rod bracket from the rear cross-member and remove the four nuts and washers securing the gearbox rear rubber mountings to the cross-member. Withdraw the rear cross-member from the body. 10. Ease the assembly forward until it is clear of the fixed body cross-member and then tilt the assembly and lift it from the car. Replacement is a reversal of the removal sequence. After refitting the unit refill with fresh oil. Section Fa.10 DISMANTLING AND REASSEMBLING Dismantling Remove the remote control assembly after withdrawing the six bolts and spring washers securing the control to the MOB. Issue 3. 65891 THE OVERDRIVE Fa adaptor and the two screws from the rear support bracket. Take care not to damage the joint washer. The unit is split at the gearbox adaptor, which is attached to the main casing by eight % in. (6.35 mm.) diameter studs, one of which is extra long. After removing the eight nuts the unit can then be drawn off the third motion shaft. Remove the operating valve plug (sce Section Fa.8). This will allow air to enter the cylinders of the operating pistons and thus facilitate their removal. Release the lock washers securing the nuts on the two operating bridge pieces and remove the nuts, lock washers, and bridge pieces. Withdraw the operating pistons by gripping their spigots with pliers. ‘As the adaptor is separated from the unit the grub screw securing the pump body can be withdrawn and the body pulled from the casing after removing the non-return valve (see Section Fa.5) ‘The main and rear casings are secured by eight % in, (6.35 mm.) diameter studs: unscrew the nuts a little at a time, gradually releasing the four clutch springs. Remove the main casing complete with brake ring. Take the fourclutch springs off their guide bolts on the thrust plate and remove the clutch assembly complete with sun wheel. The brake ring is spigoted into each casing and will come away with the main casing. A few light taps with a mallet around its flange will release the ring, Remove the sun wheel from the cone clutch boss by withdrawing the snap ring in the forward end of the sun wheel hub. Remove the large circlip and withdraw the thrust bearing and housing complete. Lift out the planet carrier assembly from the annulus. If it is necessary to remove the uni-directional roller clutch, first remove the circlip and brass retaining washer which are in front of the clutch. Place Service tool 18G 178 centrally over the clutch and lift the inner member into it. This will ensure that the rollers do not fall out of the inner member. Remove the thrust washer. DO NOT remove the outer bearing ring, as it is expanded into the annulus. A caged needle-roller bearing is fitted in the annulus centre spigot. If it is necessary to remove this use an extractor. To remove the annulus from the rear casing withdraw the speedometer pinion and bush located by one dowel screw, take off the coupling flange at the rear of the unit, and drive out the annulus from the back. The front bearing will come away on the shaft, leaving the rear bearing in the casing, Inspection Each part should be thoroughly cleaned and inspected to determine which parts need renewing. It is important to appreciate the difference between parts which are worn sufficiently to affect operation of the unit and those which are merely ‘worn in’. 1. Inspect the main casing for cracks, damage, ete Examine the bores of the operating cylinders for scores or wear. Check for leaks at the plugged ends of MGB. Issue4. 65891 the oil passages. Inspect the support bush in the centre bore for wear or damage Examine the clutch sliding member assembly. Ensure that the clutch linings are not burned or worn, inspect, the clutch spring locating bolts and bridge pieces and see that they are not distorted, Ensure that the ball bearing is in good condition and rotates freely. See that the sliding member slides easily on the splines of the sun wheel 3. Check the springs for distortion and collapse (see ‘GENERAL DATA’) 4, Inspect the teeth of the gear train for damage. If the gears are damaged or the needle rollers worn, renew the planet carrier assembly. The sun wheel bush is bored to the pitch line of the teeth, and if worn, the ‘gear will have to be renewed Examine the uni-directional clutch thrust washer, 6. See that the rollets of the uni-directional clutch are not chipped and that the outer ring is tight in the annulus, Ensure that the spring is free from distortion, 7. Inspect the output shaft ball bearings and see that there is no roughness when they are rotated slowly. 8. Ensure that there are no nicks or burrs on the third motion shaft splines and that the oil holes are open and clean, 9. Inspect the oil pump for wear on the pump plunger and roller pin. Ensure that the plunger spring is not distorted (see “GENERAL DATA’). Inspect the valve seat and ball and make sure that they are free from nicks and scratches 10. Check the operating valve for distortion and damage and see that it slides easily in its bore. Inspect the relief valve body, ‘O” ring, and ball, etc. Reassembling the unit Assemble the unit after all the parts have been thoroughly cleaned and checked to ensure that none is damaged or worn, Fig. Fas Use Service tool 18G 178 when removing or replacing the uuni-diréctional clutch inner member. Fa THE OVERDRIVE Fit the annulus assembly with the speedometer drive gear, spacing tube, and shim which fit on the shaft between the front and rear ball bearings in the rear casing. If a new bearing is fitted it becomes necessary to assess the thickness of shim required. To do this replace the annulus in the rear casing with the speedometer drive gear and distance tube in position, and with a depth gauge measure the distance between the rear ball bearing seating and the distance tube. To this figure add .005 to .010 in. (.13 to .25 mm.): this will give the actual shimming required. The shims are available in the following thicknesses for selective assembly, which should allow an end-float of .00S to .010 in. (.13 to .25 mm.) on the output shaft and no preloading of the bearings: 090 in.t.0005 in, (2.28 mm.t.01 mm.) 095 in.4.0005 in. (2.41 mm.+.01 mm.) 100 in.& 0005 in. (2.54 mm.t.01 mm.) 10S in.£.0005 in. (2.67 mm.t.01 mm.) Replace the coupling flange and tighten the nut to a torque reading of 100 to 130 Ib. fi. (13.83 to 1797 kg. m), holding the flange against rotation with the aid of a wrench (Service tool 18G34A) Fit the speedometer drive bush and pinion and lock in position with the dowel screw. Replace the thrust washer and uni-directional clutch, using Service tool 18G178 to enter the rollers in the outer ring Ensure that the spring is fitted correctly so that the cage urges the rollers up the ramp on the inner member, Fit the brass retaining washer and locate it in position with the circlip, To ensure that the second set of teeth on each planet wheel will mesh with the annulus teeth turn each planet wheel until its etched line coincides with an etched line on the carrier. insert the sun wheel to hold the planet wheel in these relative positions. Fit the assembly to the annulus and withdraw the sun wheel. AAs long as the planet cartier remains in the annulus the sun wheel can be removed and reinserted at any time. Should ihe planet carrier be removed from the annulus, the whole lining-up procedure must be repeated, ass the sun wheel into the cone clutch member and fit the small circlip at the forward end of the sun wheel. Press the thrust bearing into its housing, fit the four bolts to the ‘thrust bearing housing, and then fit the assembly onto the forward end of the cone clutch hub, securing in place with the large circlip. Fit the clutch assembly to the annulus, engaging the sun and planet wheels. Place the thrust plate and springs on the bolts Assemble the brake ring to the main casing (large end of taper towards the rear casing) with a jointing compound. Position the clutch bolts through the holes in the main casing. Start the nuts on the casing studs and gradually tighten to secure the two casings together, Ensure that the clutch spring bolts do not bind in their holes and that the casings go together easily. Fit the two operating pistons, carefully easing their rubber sealing rings into the cylinder bores (the centre spigots of Fal0 the pistons face towards the front of the unit). Fit the two bridge pieces, lock washers, and nuts. If the pump body has been removed, insert its small end into the casing in the middle hole at the bottom of the casing, ensuring that the oil inlet faces to the rear. Gently tap into position until the groove lines up with the grub serew hole at the bottom of the casing front face, Fit the grub screw and tighten, Refit the non-return valve (see Section Fa.5). Insert the pump plunger and spring from inside the casing. Replace the operating valve plug. Support the unit upright and insert a dummy shaft or a spare third motion shaft so that the planet carrier and uni-directional clutch line up with each other; a long, thin screwdriver should be used to line by eye the splines (tum anti-clockwise only) in the planet carrier and the clutch before inserting the dummy shaft. Gently turn the dummy shaft to assist in feeling it into the splines, making sure that it goes fully home. Make sure that the lowest part of the oil pump cam will contact the pump plunger and that the third motion shaft clip is seated in its groove; then with top gear engaged, carefully thread the third motion shaft into the centre bushing in the unit. Gently turn the first motion shaft to and fro to assist in engaging the splines of the planet cartier. [As the adaptor and overdrive come together watch carefully to see that the oil pump engages the cam properly. NOTE. The gearbox third motion shaft should enter the overdrive easily, provided that the lining-up procedure previously described is carried out and the unit is not disturbed. if any difficulty is experienced it is probable that one of the components has been misaligned, and the gearbox should be removed and the overdrive realigned with the dummy shaft, Replace the remote control tower, ensuring that the change speed lever engages the selector. Before assembling the planet carrer to the sun wheel rotate the planet wheels until the etched line on the planet wheel lines up with the etched line on the planet carrier MGB. Issue 2. $4980 THE OVERDRIVE Section Fa.11 DRIVE SHAFT BEARINGS AND SEAL Removing The drive shaft front bearing must be drawn from the shaft with a suitable puller. The oil seal may be removed with the overdrive in position in the car after removing the propeller shaft and drive flange. The rear bearing should be pressed from its seating with a suitable spigot. Replacing A press should be used when replacing the bearings. Fit a new oil seal. Section Fa.12 OVERDRIVE RELAY SYSTEM Description Engagement of overdrive is controlled electrically through a manually operated toggle switch. The circuit is shown in Fig. Fa.10 and includes the following components: 1. RELAY. An electro-magnetic switch used with item 2 to enable an interlocking safeguard to be incorporated against changing out of overdrive with the throttle closed. 2. THROTTLE SWITCH. A vacuum-operated switch to over-ride the toggle switch under closed throttle conditions 3. GEAR SWITCH. A small plunger-operated switch allowing overdrive to be engaged only in the two highest forward gear positions. 4. SOLENOID UNIT. An electro-magnetic actuator to engage the overdrive mechanism by opening the hydraulic control valve. Operation When the driver engages ‘overdrive’ by closing the contacts of the toggle switch, current is fed by way of the ignition switch and fuse unit supply terminal ‘A3* to energize the relay operating coil. Closure of the relay contacts connects MGB. Issued, 15676 Fa terminal ‘A3° to the gear switch and, provided third or top gear is engaged, will energize the solenoid unit and effect a change from direct drive to overdrive Change from overdrive to direct drive is effected by selecting a low gear (when the gear switch contact will open) or by moving the toggle switch to ‘NORMAL! with the throttle open (when the vacuum switch will open). If effected with the throttle closed (high manifold depression) the vacuum switch will over-ride the toggle switch, delaying the change until the engine takes up the drive. y / 6 ch Gea 9266 Fig. Fa. 10 Diagram of the overdrive electrical cizcuit 1. Fuse block. 5. Relay. 2. Ignition switeh, 6. Gearbox switch, 3. Driver's switeh, 7. Solenoid, 4. Vacuum switeh, CABLE COLOUR CODE, When a cable has two colour code letters the first denotes the ‘main colour and the second denotes the tracer colour. P. Purp. —-R. Red. W. White. _. Yellow. Fall SECTION Fb THE GEARBOX (ALL SYNCHROMESH) SECTION First motion shaft a ee BOG Front cover . ; ee Gearbox assembly ee Fb. Laygear - FRO Rear extension .. no ee - Fb Reverse idler gear. ee PBS Selector rods and forks .. ; ce Fb4 ‘Third motion shaft—non-overdrive .. ee . FT ‘Third motion shaft—with overdrive oo 0 ee BS MGB. Issue2. 22802 Fb.1 Fb THE GEARBOX (ALL SYNCHROMESH) Section Fb.1 GEARBOX ASSEMBLY Removing 1. Remove the engine and gearbox from the car~Section AL 2. Remove the starter. 3. Unscrew the bolts securing the gearbox to the engine and withdraw the gearbox. Refitting 4. Reverse the removing procedure in 1 to 3 and refill the gearbox with the correct quantity (see ‘GENERAL DATA’) of a recommended lubricant. Section Fb.2 REAR EXTENSION Removing 1. Drain the gearbox. 2. Using tool 18G 34 A to prevent rotation, unscrew the propeller shaft flange retaining nut and withdraw the flange. 3. Unscrew the bolts securing the remote-control housing to the gearbox and remove the remote control 4, Withdraw the selector interlocking arm and plate assembly, Fig. Fo.t Rear extension setting up 1. Third motion shaft 5, Rear extension. 2, Rear extension, 6. Gasket for ear extension. 3. Rear bearing circlip groove. 7. Gearbox main casing. 4, Distance tube. 8, Bearing. ‘A, Depth between bearing face and gearbox main casing face. Depth between rear extension face and bearing flange. Thickness of joint washer. . Depth from rear extension face to distance tube. ! Depth from rear extension face to bearing register. mons Fb.2 Fig, Fb.2 Drifting the first motion shaft from the casing 5. Unscrew the nuts securing the rear extension to the gearbox and withdraw the extension, ensuring that the shims fitted to the gearbox third motion shaft are not, mislaid. Dismantling The following operations are only necessary if the bearing or oil seal are to be renewed. 6. Remove and discard the oil seal 7. Remove the circlip retaining the bearing. 8. Press the bearing from the extension. Reassembling The following procedure must be carried out when fitting a new gearbox extension or if any of the third motion shaft components have been changed. 9. Calculate the thickness of shims required between the third motion shaft front bearing, and the gearbox rear extension case, as follows: a, Measure the depth A between the face of the front bearing and its housing, and add the thickness C of the joint washer. b, Measure the depth B from the joint face to the bearing register face of the rear extension. ¢. Fit shims between the extension and the face of the front bearing to bring the dimension measured in b .000 to .001 in. (.000 to .025 mm.) less than the dimension in a. Shims of .002 in, (05 mm.) and .004 in, (.10 mm.) thickness are available. 4. Fit the rear extension. 10. Calculate the thickness of shims required between the distance tube, and the third motion shaft rear bearing as follows: a. Measure the depth D between the rear face of the extension and the rear face of the distance tube. MGB. Issue 2. 22802 THE GEARBOX (ALL SYNCHROMESH) Fb b. Measure the depth E of the rear bearing register from the rear face of the extension. © Fit shims between the distance tube and the bearing to bring the dimension measured in A from .000 to .001 in. (,000 to .025 mm) less than the dimension measured in B. Shims of .002 in,(05 mm.), 005 in, (13 mm.) and .010 in, (25 mm.) thickness are available d. Press the bearing into the extension using tool 18G 186. e. Select and fit the thickest circlip that will enter the rear bearing circlip groove from the following, range: 096 to .098 in. (2.43 to 2.49 mm.) (098 to .100 in. (2.49 to 2.54 mm.) 100 to .102 in, (2.54 to 2.59 mm.) 11, Using tool 18G 134 with adaptor 18G 134 BK, fit a new oil seal. iting 12. Check that the shims on the third motion shaft are correctly positioned against the distance tube shoulder, and fit the extension. 13. Fit and tighten the extension securing nuts. 14, Reverse the removing procedure 1 to 4. Section Fb.3 FRONT COVER Removing. 1. Turn the clutch release bearing retaining clips and withdraw the bearing from the lever, 2. Remove the rubber boot from the clutch lever, 3. Unscrew the front cover retaining nuts and remove the cover, collecting the shims fitted in front of the first motion shaft bearing, Dismantling 4. Remove the oil seal and gasket 5. Unscrew the nut retaining the clutch lever pivot bolt, remove the bolt, and withdraw the lever. Reassembling ‘The following procedure must be carried out when fitting a new front cover or if any of the first motion shaft components have been changed. 6. Calculate the thickness of shims required between the front cover and the bearing, as follows: a, Measure the depth A from the face of the cover to the bearing register and add .012 in. (31 mm.) for the compressed thickness C of the joint washer, MGB. Issue2, 22802 Fig, Fb.3 Removing the lefthanded-threaded frst motion shaft nut using tool 18G 48 b. Measure the distance B that the first motion shaft bearing protrudes from the casing. ¢. Fit shims between the bearing and cover to bring the dimension measured in B from .000 to .001 in, (000 to 025 mm.) greater than the dimension in A. Shims of .002 in. (.05 mm.) and (004 in, (.10 mm.) thickness are available. Using tool 18G 134 with adaptor 18G 134 Q, fit a new oil seal to the cover. Position the clutch lever, fit the pivot bolt, serew on and tighten the bolt retaining nut, Fig. Fo Front cover setting up 1. Gearbox main casing. 3. Front cover. 2. Gasket for front cover. 4. Beating, ‘A. Depth of front cover to bearing register. B. First motion shaft bearing protrusion. C. Compressed thickness of joint washer. Fb3 fb THE GEARBOX (ALL SYNCHROMESH) Refitting 9. Reverse the removing procedure noting the following: a. Use anew gasket when refitting the cover; ensure that all traces of the old gasket are removed from the cover and gearbox jointing faces before fitting the new gasket. b. Check that the first motion shaft bearing shims are correctly positioned. Section Fb.4 SELECTOR RODS AND FORKS Removing 1, Remove the rear extension—Section Fb.3, 1 to 3-or the overdrive adaptor—Section Fe.1 2. Unscrew the side cover retaining bolts and remove the cover. 3. Remove the selector detent plunger plugs and springs. 4, Slacken the locknuts on each of the selector fork retaining bolts and remove the bolts. 5. Withdraw the selector rods and remove the selector forks, Refitting 6. Reverse the removing procedure, noting the following points: a. Clean any burrs from the rods at the fork attachment points before refitting the rods. b. Check that the detent plungers are clear of the holes before fitting the rods. Section Fb.S REVERSE IDLER GEAR Removing 1, Remove the rear extension—Section Fb.3, 1 to 3—or the overdrive adaptor- Section Fe.1, 2, Remove the selector rods and forks~Section Fb.4, 2 105, 3. Knock back the locking tab on the shaft retaining bolt and remove the bolt, 4, Remove the shaft and withdraw the gear. Inspection 5. Inspect the shaft for signs of excessive wear; renew the shaft if necessary. 6. Examine the gear teeth for wear and damage; renew the gear if necessary, Foa q 7. Inspect the gear bushes for signs of excessive wear; worn bushes may be removed and new bushes pressed in. Refitting 8. Reverse the removing procedure in 1 to 4 using a new locking washer on the shaft retaining bolt Section Fb.6 FIRST MOTION SHAFT Removing 1. Remove the rear extension-Section Fb.2, 1 to 5. 2. Remove the front cover—Section Fb.3, 1 to 3. 3. Remove the selector rods and forks-Section Fb.4, 2 to. 4, Remove the reverse idler gear Section Fb.5, 20 4. Carefully drift the layshaft from the gearbox. 6. Check that the laygear teeth are clear of the first motion shaft gear teeth. 7. Using a soft metal drift registering against the bearing outer track, carefully drift the shaft assembly forward from the gearbox. Dismantling 8. Withdraw the needle-roller bearing from inside the rear end of the shaft. 9. Tap back the locking tab on the bearing retaining nut. 10. Fit tool 18G 49 onto the nut and clamp the shaft in a soft-jawed vice Fig. FS First motion shaft bearing ‘A. Removing the bearing from the shaft. B. Refitting the bearing. MGB. Issue? 22802 THE GEARBOX (ALL SYNCHROMESH) F Db Section Fb.7 ‘THIRD MOTION SHAFT-NON-OVERDRIVE Removing 1, Remove the rear extension- Section Fb.2, 1 to 5, 2. Remove the front cover—Section Fb.3, | to 3. 3. Remove the selector rods and forks—Section Fb, 2 to. Remove the reverse idler gear—Section Fb.5, 2 to 4. WWW x Remove the first motion shaft-Section Fb.6, 5 to7. W 6. Remove the shims and distance tube from the third motion shaft. 7. Unscrew the rear extension securing studs from the gearbox casing, WWW 8. Check that the laygear teeth are clear of the gears and synchronizers. Fig, Fb Pressing out the third motion shaft using tool 18G 1045 9. Using tool 18G 1045, press the third motion shaft rearwards from the gearbox, 11, Unscrew the left-hand-threaded nut; remove the nut and lock washer. 12. Press the bearing from the shaft. Inspection 13, Inspect the shaft for signs of wear and damage to the gear or splines. 14, Examine the bearings for wear and damage; renew the bearing as necessary. Reassembling 15. Reverse the dismantling procedure in 8 to 12, using a new shaft nut locking washer. Refitting 16. Carefully drift the assembled shaft into the casing ensuring that the laygear teeth do not foul the shaft . Fig. Fo gear teeth. ‘sing tool 186 1024 to remo te font ear looking nut for 17. Reverse the removing procedure in 1 to 6. Dismantling SHAFT ASSEMBLY 10. Check the end-loat on the first, second, and third speed gears against the figures given in ‘GENERAL DATA’. 11, Withdraw the third and fourth speed synchronizer assembly complete with baulk rings 12. Tap back the locking tabs on front gear locking nut; unscrew the nut using tool 18G 1024 and remove the lock washer. 13, Withdraw the shaft sleeve, third speed gear, and interlocking thrust washer. Fig. Fb7 ‘Checking the frst and second speed gear end-float 14, Withdraw the second speed gear and thrust washer. MGB. Issue 2, 22802 FbS Fb 15, Remove the first and second speed synchronizer assembly complete with baulk rings 16. Withdraw the speedometer gear and remove the gear driving key. 17. Remove the shaft distance piece. 18. Press the first speed gear, reverse gear, and the bearing complete with housing from the shaft (see Fig. Fb.9). 19. Press the bearing from its housing (see Fig. Fb.10).. Synchronizers 20. Remove the baulk rings 21. Wrap a cloth loosely around the assembly to retain the balls and springs and push the synchronizer hub from the sliding coupling. Fig. Fo.9 ‘Third motion shaft A, Pressing off the first speed and reverse gears and bearing with housing. B, Refitting gears and bearing Inspection 22. If the end-float on the gears when checked in 10 exceeds the figures given, inspect the relevant gear and thrust washer bearing faces for wear. Renew worn ‘gears and thrust washers as necessary. 23. Examine the gears, hubs, and couplings for wear and damaged or worn parts; replace as necessary. 24. Inspect the shaft for wear and damage to splines and bearing surfaces. 25. Examine the bearing for wear and damage. 26. Check the synchronizer springs against the dimension and pressure given in ‘GENERAL DATA’. Reassembling SYNCHRONIZERS 21. Fit tool 18G 1026 over the synchronizer hub. Fb6 7 THE GEARBOX (ALL SYNCHROMESH) ‘Third motion shaft bearing A. Removing the bearing from its housing, B. Refitting the bearing 28. Turn the hub until one of the spring pockets is in line with the hole in the tool 29. Fit the spring and ball into the pocket; depress the ball and turn the hub so that the ball is retained by the tool 30. Repeat operations 28 and 29 for the remaining ball and springs. 31. Line up the cit-outs in the coupling with those in the hub and enter the hub into the coupling. 32. Press the hub from the tool into the coupling so that the springs and balls are retained by the coupling as the tool is removed. 33. Fit the baulk rings to the hub. NOTE.—The baulk rings of the two synchronizer assemblies are not interchangeable. The first and second speed synchronizer baulk rings are identified (see Fig. Fb.14) by a drill point on one of the baulk ring lugs or by the fillets at the base of the lugs. eo "posse Fig. Fo. Dimensions of tool for refitting the third motion shaft A= 19 in (483 mm.) B=3in. (76mm) C= 275 in. (69 mm.) MGB. Issue 2, 22802 THE GEARBOX (ALL SYNCHROMESH) Fb ©. After reassembly re-check the end-float on the first, second, and third speed gears. Refitting 35. Enter the assembled shaft into the gearbox from the rear; ensure that the third and fourth speed synchronizer assembly is fitted to the shaft. 36. Check that the laygear teeth are clear of the shaft gears. 37. Using a fabricated tool to the dimensions shown in Fig. Fb.11 registering on the outer track of the bearing, press the shaft assembly into the gearbox. 38. Reverse the removing procedure in 1 to 5 - Section Fb Fig. Fb.12 assembling the synchronizers using tool 18G 1026 ee can THIRD MOTION SHAFT—WITH OVERDRIVE Removing 1. Remove the overdrive unit and adaptor—Section Fe.1, SHAFT ASSEMBLY 21010 34, Reverse the dismantling procedure in 10 to 19, noting Carry out the operation for removing the the following points: non-overdrive third motion shaft given in Section a, Ensure that the lugs on the shaft sleeve are Fb.7,2 to 9, aligned with the cut-outs in the interlocking thrust washers. b. The synchronizer assemblies may be fitted either way round, but their baulk rings or the complete assemblies must not be interchanged with each other. Fig, Fb. ‘The identification drill point or fillets on the lugs ofthe frst ‘and second speed synchronizer baulk rings Dismantling 3. Carry out operations in Section Fb.7, 10 to 15 4, Tap back the locking tab on rear shaft nut, 5. Using tool 18G 391, unscrew the nut and remove the locking washer. 6. Withdraw the distance piece. 7. Carry out operations in Section Fb.7, 18 to 21 Inspection 8. Carry out operations in Section Fb.7, 22 to 26 Reassembling 9. Carry out operations in Section Fb.7, 27 to 33. 10, Reverse the dismantling procedure in 3 to 7. Refitting 11, Reverse the removi i ree 1. Reverse the removing procedure in Seton Fb, 210 Refittng the assembled third motion shaft using the fabricated tool 12, Refit the overdrive unit and adaptor—Section Fe.9, MGB. Issue 2. 22802 Fb.7 Fb THE GEARBOX (ALL SYNCHROMESH) Section Fb.9 LAYGEAR Removing Remove the rear extension—Section Fb.2, 1 to 5. Remove the front cover~Section Fb.3, 1 to 3. Remove the selector rods and forks~Section Fb.4, 2 to5. 4, Remove the reverse idler gear—Section Fb.5, 2 to 4, 5. Remove the first motion shaft~Section Fb.6, 5 to 7. 6. Remove the third motion shaft—Section Fb.7, 6 to 9. 7. Temporarily refit the layshaft and check the laygear end-float, 8. Withdraw the layshaft and remove the laygear and its thrust washers. Dismantling 9. Withdraw the needle-roller bearings from inside the laygear. Inspection 10. Inspect the layshaft for wear and damage to the bearing surfaces. 11, Examine the roller bearings for wear and damage. 12. Inspect the laygear teeth for damage and the bearing faces and bore for wear. Reassembling 13. Fit the needle-roller bearings into the laygear. n the Taygear and front (large) thrust washer; enter the layshaft through the housing and thrust washer, and into the laygear. 15. If the laygear end-float measured in 7 is outside the limits given, select @ rear thrust washer to give the correct end-float, Fos. 16. 17. 18. 19, 20. 21 22, Fig. Fb.15 Using tool 18G 391 to unscrew the rear nut on the overdrive gearbox third motion shaft Rear thrust washers are available in the following thicknesses: 154 to .156 in. (3.91 to 3.96 mm.) 157 to .158 in. (3.99 to 4.01 mm.) 160 to .161 in. (4.06 to 4.08 mm.) 163 to .164 in, (4.14 to 4.16 mm.) Fit the rear thrust washer and thread a piece of soft wire through the housing, thrust washer, and into the laygear. Withdraw the layshaft, at the same time thread the wire through the laygear and front thrust washer. This will enable the laygear and thrust washers to be retained ready for refitting the layshaft, and at the same time allow sufficient movement of the laygear to prevent the gear teeth obstructing the gears on the first and third motion shafts during refitting. Refit the third motion shaft-Section Fb.7, 35 to 37. Refit the first motion shaft~Section Fb.6, 16. Use the wite to align the laygear and thrust washers. Enter the layshaft, plain end first, into the front of the casing; line up the cut-away in the end of the shaft with the front cover recess and press the shaft home. Reverse the removing procedure in 1 to 4. MGB. Issue 2. 22802 SECTION Fe THE OVERDRIVE (TYPE LH.) SECTION Fault diagnosis .. . - ~ . . 7 “ Pe.2 Filters . . . ” . - ~ . Fes General description 5 . Fel Hydraulic pressure test a - - * . . . Fe3 Lubrication, * . ~ + + . . 7 Fe4 Overdrive assembly . . - ” - 7 ve . . Feo Pump and non-return vale. Fes Relief and low pressure valve... ne Feb Solenoid vaNe ae Fed MGB. Issue 1. 15676 Fel MGB. Issue 1. 15676 33. Pump body. 66. Sump. 99. Nut 100. Split pin. i KEY TO THE OVERDRIVE COMPONENTS (TYPE L.H.) No. Description No. Description No. Description 1. Adaptor plate. 34, Nonsetuen vale sat 67. Washer 2 Gasket 35. Valve bath. 68, sere. 3. Nut 36. Valve spring. 69, Brokering. 4. Tab washer 37. Pump plug 70. Clutch sing member 5. Bridge-piece 38. ‘O° ring 71. Planet carter assembly. 6. Operating piston 39, Low pressure valve plug 12, Oitcateher. 1 40. Valve spring 73. Cittip. i 8 41, Valve bal. 74, Oil thrower. 9. Spring 42. Pump plunger 15. Unidirectional clutch. 10. Thrust rod 43. Low pressure vale body 16, ‘Thrust washer. 1 Spring 44, Washer. 17. Bus 12, Washer. 45. Relie valve spring 78. Annulus. 13, ‘Thrust housing pin, 46. Valve plunger. 79, Nut 14, Citclip. 47. Valve boy. 80. Washer. 15. Key. 48. Filter. 81. Stud | 16. sta. 49.0" ring 82. Spring rin. £ an, Steet ba. 50. “O° ring 83. Rear casing $8. Plog 41, Washer. 84, Annalus front bearing. i 19. Grommet. $2. Plug 85. Spacer. i 20, Sun whee! thrust bush. 53. ‘O' ring. 86, Speedometer drive gear. i $21, sun wheel bush 4, _ Solenoid vale body. 87. Selective spacer. 22. Girclip 58, 88, Anmulus rear beating i 23. San whes 56 9, speedometer driven, | 24. Citcip. 57. Screw. 90, Sealing washer. i By oes 58. Solenoid cot 91. Syewtemetr bag ! 26. Thrust balbrace 59. Valve bal 92. Oitsweal i 27. ‘Thrust ring. 60. ‘O" ring. 93. Retaining clip. j 28. Pumpcam, 61, Solenoid pnger. 94, Washer. 29. Main casing. 62. Gasket, 95. Bolt 30, Pump suction tube 63. Solenoid cover. 96. Oilseat ban spine 64. Samp iter and se 92 Dive tage 320° ring 65. Pltermagets 98. Water, MGB. Issue 1, 15676 Fe3 Fe Section Fe. GENERAL DESCRIPTION The Laycock Type L.H. Overdrive fitted between the gearbox and propeller shaft is a self-contained gear unit which provides a higher overall gear ratio than that given by the final drive. The overdrive gears consist of a central sun wheel and three planet gears which mesh with an internally toothed annulus. Fitted inside the annulus is a uni-directional clutch. A sliding clutch-member is secured to the sun wheel and is free to move forward and rearward on the sun wheel splines. Attached to a ball bearing, secured on the sliding THE OVERDRIVE (TYPE L.H.) clutch by a circlip, is a static thrust ring. The thrust ring is actuated by two hydraulic pistons and returned by primary and secondary return springs An electrically operated solenoid valve, mechanical pump, relief valve, and low pressure valve comprise the main components of the hydraulic system. Overdrive engaged With the overdrive switch selected the solenoid is energized and the ball valve is held in the closed position by the solenoid rod. ‘The input shaft to the overdrive unit carries a cam which operates the overdrive oil pump. The pump draws oil from 0872 Sump. Magnet filters. Gauze filter Pump. Third motion shatt (gearbox) 6. Control switch 7. Solenoid operating valve 8. Low pressure valve, 9. Relief valve 10. Operating pistons, 11. Oil etuen to sump. ig, Fe.2 Overdrive engaged Fed MGB. Issue 1. 15676 THE OVERDRIVE (TYPE L.H.) Fe 2 6 Fig. Fe3 Direct drive 1. Thitd motion shaft. 2. Spring pressure. 4. Sun wheel 5. Cone clutch, 6. Unidirectional clutch. the sump and the oil from the pump discharge is ducted to the two operating pistons of the clutch stiding member, A build-up of oil pressure operates the two pistons and moves the sliding clutch-member, its outer brake surface contacts the stationary brake ring and the complete sliding member and sun wheel cease to rotate. At a predetermined spring pressure the relief valve operates and relieves any pressure, in excess of the pressure required to keep the pistons operative, into the low pressure lubricating system. Build-up of pressure in the low pressure lubricating system is relieved by operation of the low pressure valve and the oil relieved returns to the sump. ‘The planet gear carrier is splined to, and rotates with, the input shaft. The planet gears, forced to turn about their own axis by movement of the carrier, while in mesh with the stationary sun wheel, impart driving force to turn the annulus. Because of the gearing arrangement the annulus turns faster than the input shaft. The propeller shaft, coupled to a flange rigidly secured to the shaft of the annulus, revolves at the same speed as the annulus. In overdrive the outer bearing surface of the uni-directional clutch inside the annulus, over-rides the rollers, cage, and clutch, attached to the slower-moving input shaft. In this condition the uni-directional clutch is in the unlocked or free condition. The solenoid valve acts as a safety valve. If the pressure becomes excessive the ball would be blown off its seat against the load of the solenoid. MGB. Issue 1. 15676 Overdrive disengaged : CAUTION.—IF OVERDRIVE DOES NOT DISENGAGE, DO NOT REVERSE THE CAR OTHERWISE EXTENSIVE DAMAGE MAY RESULT. With the overdrive switch in the ‘of? position the operating solenoid is de-energized and the valve ball is free to move away from the valve seat, Oil from the pump discharge lifts the valve from its seat, flows to the low pressure valve, and is used for lubrication. This action relieves the oil pressure ‘maintaining the pistons operative. The return springs act to close the pistons and the oil retuming from the piston chambers is forced to mix with the pump flow, thus causing a restriction and damping the return movement of the sliding member, Action of the secondary return springs force the clutch sliding member rearward and its inner brake surface contacts the annulus brake ring. The sliding member and annulus commence to revolve in unison, As the sun wheel is splined to the sliding clutch member the complete gear train is locked. ‘Thrust from the input shaft locks the uni-directional clutch against the outer bearing surface, inside the annulus, and direct drive is applied to the propeller shaft through the annulus extension on which the propeller shaft coupling flange is mounted. During over-run and reverse, additional load is imparted to the clutch sliding member by the helix thrust of the sun wheel, thus helping to retain direct drive, Fig. Fes ‘Overdrive engaged 3, Hydraulic pressure. 7. Brake ring 8. Planet wheel 9. Planet cartier. 10. Annulus. Fes THE OVERDRIVE (TYPE L.H.) 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 Sun wheel thrust bush, ‘Snap ring for sun wheel. Bearing retainer plate. “Thrust bearing 1 2 3 4 5. Main easing 6. Grooved pin. 7. Brake ting. 8. Planet wheel 9. Planet bearing. 10. Cirtp. 11. Rollers for unidirectional clutch. 12, Annulus front bearing. 13. Rear eas 14, Speedometer driving gear. 15. Annulus rear bearing. 16. Drive flange. 17, Washer. 18, Nut Fe6 A section through the overdrive unit 19. 20. a. 2. 23, m4, 2s, Oil seal Selective spacer. Spacer. Bush. Thrust washer. Unisdirectional clutch, inner member. Unidirectional clutch, outer member. Oi thrower. Annulus. Inner Lining of clutch sliding ‘member Outer lining of clutch sliding member. (Clutch stiding member, ‘Sump filter and gasket assembly. Sump. Thrust bearing housing. Citetip. 24 2 22 21 ows Fitter. Pump plug. Non-return valve spring. “0° ring. Non-return valve ball. Non-return valve seat Pump body. Main case housing for pump. Pump plunger. Spring for pump plunger. Pin for pump roller. Pump roller. Gearbox third motion shatt. Key for pump cam. Cirelip. Pump cam. Main case housing for sun wheel and oll transfer bush, MGB. Issue 1, 15676 THE OVERDRIVE (TYPE L.H.) Fe Section Fe.2 FAULT DIAGNOSIS OVERDRIVE DOES NOT ENGAGE (1) Insufficient oil in gearbox (2) Electrical system fault .. (3) Low hydraulic pressure: (a) Pump non-return valve not seating (b) Solenoid ball valve not seating .. (©) Pump filter choked .. (4) Damaged parts within unit OVERDRIVE DOES NOT DISENGAGE NOTE.— (5) Electrical control system Fault (6). Sticking clutch (7) Damaged parts within unit OVERDRIVE SLIPS WHEN ENGAGED (8) Insufficient oil in gearbox (9) Low hydraulie pressure (a) Pump non-return valve not seating (b) Relief valve not seating (c) Solenoid valve not seating : (A) Partially blocked pump or relief valve filter (10) Worn or glazed clutch lining. SLIP IN REVERSE OR FREE WHEEL ON OVER-RUN (11) Worn or glazed clutch lining on (12) Broken circlip on sun wheel... Section Fe.3 HYDRAULIC PRESSURE TEST Check the gearbox oil level, and top up as necessary. Raise and support the rear of the car so that the rear wheels are clear of the ground. 3. Securely chock the front wheels. . 4. Remove the relief valve plug and its sealing washer. 5. Fit adaptor 18G 251 E, using the relief valve plug sealing washer, into the relief valve orifice. 6. Connect pressure gauge 18G 251. Start the engine, engage top gear and select overdrive. 8. Set the speed to a speedometer reading of 30 m.p.h. (48 km.p.h.) and note the pressure gauge reading; the correct reading is 400 to 420 Ib./sq. in. (28 to 29.5, kg.Jem.*). NOTE.—No pressure reading will be recorded with the overdrive disengaged. MGB. Issue 1. 15676 Top up to correct level, Check and rectify fault; check operation of solenoid. Remove and check the valve; clean or renew. Remove and check the valve; clean or renew. Remove and clean filter. Remove, dismantle, and inspect unit. If the overdrive does not disengage, do not reverse the car as extensive damage may result. Check and rectify fault (On a new unit this may be due to insufficient bedding-in of the clutch. The clutch can usually be freed by giving the brake-ring, accessible from beneath the car, several sharp blows with a hide mallet. Remove, dismantle, and inspect unit. Top up to correct level, Remove and check the valve; clean or renew. Remove and check the valve; clean or renew. Remove and check the valve; clean or renew. Remove and clean filters. Remove, dismantle, and replace faulty parts. Remove, dismantle, and replace faulty parts Remove, dismantle, and replace faulty parts. Fig. Feb Pressure gauge 18G 251 and adaptor 18G 251 E connected to check the hydraulic pressure Fe.7 Fe THE OVERDRIVE (TYPE L.H.) Section Fe.4 LUBRICATION IMPORTANT.—Anti-friction additives must not be used in the gearbox and overdrive. Draining 1. Remove the gearbox drain plug to drain the oil from the gearbox and overdrive unit. Filling 2. Remove the gearbox dipstick and add the correct quantity (see “GENERAL DATA’) of one of the recommended lubricants. 3. Run the car for a short distance, allow to stand for a few minutes and check the level with the dipstick. Section Fe.S FILTERS Sump 1, Drain the gearbox and overdrive unit 2. Clean the sump cover and its surroundings. 3. Unscrew the sump cover securing screws and remove the cover and sump filter 4, Clean all metallic particles from the two magnets fitted inside the cover; wash the cover and filter in petrol (gasoline). 5. Refit the filter and sump cover. 6. Refill the gearbox and overdrive unit with the correct quantity (see ‘GENERAL DATA’) of one of the recommended lubricants. Relief valve 7. Drain the gearbox and overdrive unit. 8. Remove the relief valve plug and sealing washer, 9. Withdraw the relief valve body and remove the filter. 10. Clean the filter in petrol (gasoline). 11. Refit the filter to the valve body. 12, Refit the valve body assembly, sealing washer, and plug. 13, Refill the gearbox and overdrive unit recommended lubricant. with a Section Fc.6 RELIEF AND LOW PRESSURE VALVE Removing 1. Drain the gearbox and overdrive unit. 2. Remove the relief valve plug and sealing washer. 3, Withdraw the relief valve assembly. Dismantling 4. Remove the filter, spacer tube, low pressure valve assembly, and relief valve spring. 5. Remove the relief valve plunger. Fe8 Inspection 6 Examine the relief valve plunger and seat for pitting, scoring, and wear. Renew worn or damaged parts as necessary. 7. Inspect the relief valve body ‘O° rings for signs of deterioration, and renew if necessary. 8. Check the relief valve spring for signs of collapse or weakness against the figures given in ‘GENERAL DATA’, 9. Test the low pressure valve for correct setting. The complete valve must be renewed if faulty Reasembling 10. Reverse the dismantling procedure in 4 and 5. Refitting 1. Reverse the removing procedure in 2 and 3, noting that the spacer tube must be fitted with its slotted end farthest from the filter with the slots lining up respectively with the oil outlet hole and locating stud, Section Fe.7 SOLENOID VALVE Removing. 1. Drain the gearbox and overdrive unit. 2, Unscrew the four screws securing the solenoid cover (name plate) and remove the cover and gasket. 3. Remove the solenoid and valve assembly by carefully pulling on the solenoid lead, Dismantling 4, Withdraw the solenoid rod and operating valve assembly from the solenoid housing Fig. Fe-7 Removing the pump retaining plug using tool 18G 1118, MGB. Issue 1. 15676 THE OVERDRIVE (TYPE L.H.) Fe 5, Press the solenoid coil and base cap from the housing 6. Remove the operating valve plunger and ball by shaking from the solenoid rod, Inspection 7. Examine the valve ball and seat for pitting and scoring and renew damaged parts; the ball may be reseated by light tapping onto the seat using a suitable drift. 8. Inspect the ‘O° ring seals for signs of deterioration, and renew as necessary. Reassembling 9. Reverse the dismantling procedure 4 to 6. Refitting 10. Reverse the removing procedure in 2 and 3, ensuring that the lead grommet is pressed fully into its slot, and using a new gasket under the solenoid cover. Section Fe8 PUMP AND NON-RETURN VALVE Removing 1. Drain the gearbox and overdrive unit 2. Remove the sump filter-Section Fe.5, 2 and 3. 3. Using tool 18G 1118, unscrew the pump retaining plug. 4, Remove the non-return valve spring and ball 5. Remove the pump body, the pump plunger spring and plunger, Dismantling 6. Using a suitable drift, separate the non-return valve seat from the pump body taking care not to damage the bore of the pump body. Inspection, 7. Examine the and renew where necessary. 8. Examine the non-return valve ball and seat for scoring and pitting, and renew damaged parts; the ball may be reseated by lightly tapping onto its seat using a suitable drift ” ring seals for signs of deterioration, Reassembling 9. Carefully refit the non-return valve seat to the pump body. Refitting 10. Insert the pump plunger into the casing, ensuring that the flat side of the plunger is towards the rear of the overdrive unit and retain in position with tool 18G 117. 11. Reverse the removing procedure in 2 to 5. MGB. Issue 1. 15676 Fig. Fe-8 Using tool 18G 1117 to retain the pump components Section Fe9 OVERDRIVE ASSEMBLY Removing OVERDRIVE UNIT I. Remove the engine and gearbox from the car as described in Section A. Remove the gearbox drain plug and drain the oil from the gearbox and overdrive. 3. Unscrew the six bolts securing the remote control assembly to the gearbox and remove the remote control. 4, Remove the eight nuts from the studs securing the overdrive unit to the gearbox adaptor. 5. Withdraw the overdrive unit from the gearbox adaptor. OVERDRIVE ADAPTOR 6. Remove the overdrive unit as in 1 to 5. 7. Slide the overdrive pump driving cam from the gearbox shaft and remove the cam locking ball from its pocket in the shaft. 8. Using tool 18G 1004, remove the pump cam circlip from the shaft, 9. Withdraw the selector interlocking arm and plate assembly, 10. Unscrew the eight nuts securing the adaptor to the ‘gearbox and withdraw the adaptor. Dismantling 11, Remove the solenoid cover and gasket. 12. Withdraw the solenoid and plunger. 13. Remove the relief valve assembly. 14, Remove the sump and filter. 15. Using tool 18G 1118, unscrew the pump retaining plug and remove the pump components. 16. Remove the speedometer drive retaining clip, drive gear, and sealing washer. Fed THE OVERDRIVE (TYPE L.H.) 18, 19. 20. 28. Fig, Feo Using the bridge-pieces to remove the thrust rods, Unscrew the six rear retaining stud nuts and the two front nuts securing the rear casing to the main casing assembly, Separate the rear casing from the main casing and remove the planet gear assembly. Unlock and remove the nuts securing the bridge pieces, and pistons in the main casing, Remove the bridge piece, pistons, clutch sliding member, brake-ring and sun wheel Remove the four clutch springs and selective washers. Lever the sun wheel split-ring from the retaining groove and push out the sun wheel. ift off the bearing retaining plate. Using tool 18G 257, remove the bearing circlip. Drift the clutch sliding member from the bearing. Press the bearing from its housing Fit the four studs in the thrust ring and insert the studs into the thrust rods from the rear of the main casing. Lay one bridge-piece on its side across one of the piston chambers and fit the remaining bridgepiece, Fig. Fe.10 Using too! 18G 34A to prevent the drive flange from rotating Fe.10 34, 36. 37, 38. 39, inverted to its normal assembly position, on the two adjacent thrust ring studs and secure with two nuts, Tighten both nuts evenly until the springs are compressed. Remove the citclips securing the thrust rods and springs. Slacken the two nuts evenly until the spring pressure is relieved and remove the nuts. Repeat the operations in 28 to 31 for the remaining thrust rods. Unlock the flange nut, using tool 18G 34A to prevent the shaft turning; remove the nut and washer and withdraw the fl Press the annulus forward out of the rear casing complete with the front bearing. If the bearing remains in the housing, carefully drift it out with a drift registering on the inner bearing track. Remove the spacer, speedometer driving gear and selective spacer, noting the position of the selective spacer which is identified by a groove cut in its periphery. Doves Fig. Fell Fitting the rear bearing using tool 186 186 Press out the rear bearing and oil seal. Remove the front bearing from the annulus if it has been retaining to the shaft. Remove the split ring, oil thrower ting, and uni-directional clutch, collecting the rollers as they come free, Remove the thrust washer. MGB Issue 1. 15676 THE OVERDRIVE (TYPE L.H.) Inspection 40. Thoroughly clean the components in a cleaning solvent and dry them using lint-free or nylon material or compressed air. 41, Thoroughly examine each component for damage and excessive wear 42. Examine the bearings for pitting or scoring of the tracks and balls. 43. Check the springs for weakness, collapse or distortion against the following: 44, Inspect the pistons and bores for signs of scoring. 45. Examine the rubber components for signs of deterioration. 46. Inspect the clutch for worn or charred linings and loose rivets. If the clutch is defective a complete new clutch sliding member must be fitted. 47. Examine the shaft splines for signs of wear and damage. 48. Check the condition of the sun wheel bush. If the bush is defective a complete new sun wheel assembly must be fitted. 49. Examine the selective washers for wear. If worn, a new set (four) of washers must be fitted Reassembling 50, Press the front bearing into its housing in the rear casing, ensuring that the outer track of the bearing is firmly against the shoulder of the casing, 51. Press the annulus into the front bearing 52. Fit the spacer, speedometer driving gear, and selective washer, 53. If the rear casing, annulus, speedometer gear, or spacer have been renewed, proceed as follows: a, Using dial gauge 18G 191, take a reading from the rear face of the selective washer (Fig, Fe.12). b. Take another reading from the shoulder of the rear bearing housing c. The dimension in a should be .010 in, (.254 mm.) +$@in. (.127 mm,) greater than the Fig, Fe-12 Using dik gauge 18G 191 to take measurements for the Selective washer, Inset shows: 1. Rear tace of the selective washer. 2. Shoulder of the bearing housing. dimension taken in b. If the correct reading is, not obtained, check that the front bearing and annulus are firmly in contact with the shoulders of their respective housings No. of Wire Free Fitted | Loadat coils diameter length length fitted length Clutch engagement 3% 098 in, 78in. S2in. 65 Ib. (2.5 mm.) (19.8 mm.) (13.2 mm.) (29.5 kg) Clutch release % 128 in, 85 in. 625 in 150 1b. (3mm) (21.6 mm) (15.9 mm) (68 ke.) Relief valve 8 092 in. 1.182 in. 995 in. 38.35 Ib (2.3mm) GOmm,) (25.3 mm) (17.5 kg) Pump 7 064 in. 1.75 in, 896 in 10.99 1b. (1.6mm) (44.5 mm) (22.8 mm) (kg) MGB. Issue. 15676 Fell Fe THE OVERDRIVE (TYPE L.H.) 54, 55, 56. 31. Doses Fig. Fe.13 Fitting the rear oil seal using tool 18G 177 d. If the correct reading is still unobtainable, select a new selective washer to suit. Washers are available in the following thicknesses 360 in. (9.1 mm.) 380 in. (9.7 mm.) 365 in. (9.3 mm.) 385 in, (9.8 mm.) 370 in. (9.4 mm.) 390 in. (9.9 mm.) 375 in.(9.5 mm.) Using tool 18G 186, fit the rear bearing, Smear the outer case of the new rear oil seal with grease, and fit the seal fully into its housing using tool 18G 177. Fit the rear flange, tighten the nut to the torque figure given in ‘GENERAL DATA’ and lock the nut using a new split pin. Fit the thrust ring. Fig. Fe.14 Assembling the uni-directional clutch using tool 18G 178 Fel? bi 58. 59. 60. 61. 62. 63. 64, 65. Fit the spring of the uni-directional clutch to the inner clutch member, and the inner member and spring into the clutch cage, then insert the assembly into tool 18G 178 and fit the clutch rollers. Fit the uni-directional clutch assembly and remove tool 18G 178. Fit the oil thrower and split ring and check that the clutch rotates in an anti-clockwise direction. Rotate each planet wheel until the centre punch mark is radially outwards and in line with the wheel shaft locking pin. Insert the sun wheel into the planet carrier and recheck the alignment of the planet wheel markings. Install the assembled planet carried into the annulus. Remove the sun wheel. Using tool 18G 185, align the splines in the planet carrier and uni-directional clutch, 66. 67. 68. Fig. Fes Using tool 18G 185 to align the splines Refit the four clutch release thrust rods using the dismantling method in 27 to 32; fit new citclips if required Refit the pistons. Reassemble the clutch sliding member and components by reversing the procedure in 21 to 26, ensuring that the four selective washers fitted are a complete set. MGB. Issue 1. 15676 THE OVERDRIVE (TYPE L.H.) Fe 69. Fit the sun wheel, brake ring and clutch sliding member reversing the procedure in 19 to 21 and noting that the jointing faces of the brake ring must be smeared with a liquid jointing compound and the nuts locked using new tab washers, 70. Smear the jointing faces of the two casings with liquid jointing compound and assemble the casings ensuring that the sun wheel meshes with the planet gears. 71. Fit and tighten the retaining nuts and spring washers. 72. Reverse the dismantling procedure in 11 to 16. Refitting OVERDRIVE ADAPTOR 73. Reverse the removing procedure in 6 to 10. OVERDRIVE UNIT ‘The planot wheels correctly positioned for fiting the sun 74, Reverse the removing procedure in 1 to 5 ‘wheel and assembling inthe annulis MGB. Issue}. 15676 Fe.13 SECTION Fd THE AUTOMATIC GEARBOX, Adjustments Air pressure test Centre support and planet gears Converter Fault diagnosis Driven shaft and ring gear Fault diagnosis Front clutch Front servo Governor assembly and speedometer drive Maintenance Manual valve shaft and lever Pressure test—down-shift valve cable Pump Rear clutch. Rear servo .. Road test procedure Selector Stall test Torque converter ~ Transmission assembly Valve bodies assembly... MGB. Issue 1. 15676 SECTION Fas Fa9 Fa.19 Fa4 Fd.20 Fao Fa17 Faia Fa.12 Fa.2 Fa21 Fa7 Fd.16 Fa18 Fa.15 Fd3 Fd. Fas Fall F410 F413 Fd Fat Fd (NOILIAS TYNIGALIDNOT) XOMUAVAD OLLVWOLAV FHL MGB. Issue 1, 15676 Fa2

You might also like